blob: 7f42fb7178058f7b3b324297091465c9c4b5b995 [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn,
Douglas Gregore9d62932011-07-15 16:25:15 +000041 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
42 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
43 ExprResult E = S.Owned(new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(),
44 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo));
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000045 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
46 if (E.isInvalid())
47 return ExprError();
48 return move(E);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000049}
50
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000051static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
52 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000053 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +000054 bool CStyle,
55 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000056
57static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
58 QualType &ToType,
59 bool InOverloadResolution,
60 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
61 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000062static OverloadingResult
63IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
64 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
65 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
66 bool AllowExplicit);
67
68
69static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
70CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
71 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
72 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
73
74static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
75CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
76 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
77 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
78
79static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
80CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
81 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
82 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
83
84
85
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000086/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
87/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000088ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000089GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
90 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
91 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
92 ICC_Identity,
93 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
94 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
95 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000096 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000097 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
98 ICC_Promotion,
99 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000100 ICC_Promotion,
101 ICC_Conversion,
102 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000103 ICC_Conversion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
105 ICC_Conversion,
106 ICC_Conversion,
107 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000108 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000109 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000110 ICC_Conversion,
111 ICC_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000113 ICC_Conversion
114 };
115 return Category[(int)Kind];
116}
117
118/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
119/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
120ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
121 static const ImplicitConversionRank
122 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
123 ICR_Exact_Match,
124 ICR_Exact_Match,
125 ICR_Exact_Match,
126 ICR_Exact_Match,
127 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000128 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000129 ICR_Promotion,
130 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000131 ICR_Promotion,
132 ICR_Conversion,
133 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000134 ICR_Conversion,
135 ICR_Conversion,
136 ICR_Conversion,
137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000139 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000140 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000141 ICR_Conversion,
142 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000143 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
144 ICR_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000145 ICR_Conversion,
146 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000147 };
148 return Rank[(int)Kind];
149}
150
151/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
152/// implicit conversion.
153const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000154 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000155 "No conversion",
156 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
157 "Array-to-pointer",
158 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000159 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000160 "Qualification",
161 "Integral promotion",
162 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000163 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000164 "Integral conversion",
165 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000166 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000167 "Floating-integral conversion",
168 "Pointer conversion",
169 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000170 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000171 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000172 "Derived-to-base conversion",
173 "Vector conversion",
174 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000175 "Complex-real conversion",
176 "Block Pointer conversion",
177 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000178 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000179 };
180 return Name[Kind];
181}
182
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000183/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
184/// sequence to the identity conversion.
185void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
186 First = ICK_Identity;
187 Second = ICK_Identity;
188 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000189 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000190 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000191 ReferenceBinding = false;
192 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000193 IsLvalueReference = true;
194 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
195 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000196 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000197 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000198 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000199}
200
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000201/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
202/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
203/// implicit conversions.
204ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
205 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
206 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
207 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
208 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
209 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
210 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
211 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
212 return Rank;
213}
214
215/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
216/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000217/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000218/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000219bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000220 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
221 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
222 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
223 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000224 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000225 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
226 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
227 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000228 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000229 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
230 return true;
231
232 return false;
233}
234
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000235/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
236/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
237/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
238/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000239bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000240StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000241isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000242 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000243 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000244
245 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
246 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
247 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
248 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
249 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
250
Douglas Gregor5d3d3fa2011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000251 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000252 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000253 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
254
255 return false;
256}
257
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000258/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
259/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
260void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000261 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000262 bool PrintedSomething = false;
263 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000265 PrintedSomething = true;
266 }
267
268 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
269 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000270 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000271 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000272 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000273
274 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000275 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000276 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000277 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000278 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000279 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000280 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000281 PrintedSomething = true;
282 }
283
284 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
285 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000286 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000287 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000288 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000289 PrintedSomething = true;
290 }
291
292 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000293 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000294 }
295}
296
297/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
298/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
299void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000300 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000301 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
302 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000303 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000304 }
Benjamin Kramerb11416d2010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000305 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000306 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000307 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000308 After.DebugPrint();
309 }
310}
311
312/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
313/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
314void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000315 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000316 switch (ConversionKind) {
317 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000318 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000319 Standard.DebugPrint();
320 break;
321 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000322 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000323 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
324 break;
325 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000326 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000327 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000328 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000329 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000330 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000331 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000332 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000333 break;
334 }
335
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000336 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000337}
338
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000339void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
340 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
341}
342
343void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
344 conversions().~ConversionSet();
345}
346
347void
348AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
349 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
350 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
351 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
352}
353
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000354namespace {
355 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
356 // template parameter and template argument information.
357 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
358 TemplateParameter Param;
359 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
360 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
361 };
362}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000363
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000364/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
365/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
366OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000367static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
368 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000369 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000370 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
371 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
372 Result.Data = 0;
373 switch (TDK) {
374 case Sema::TDK_Success:
375 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000376 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
377 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000378 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000379
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000380 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000381 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000382 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
383 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000384
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000385 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000386 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000387 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
388 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000389 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
390 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
391 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
392 Result.Data = Saved;
393 break;
394 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000395
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000396 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000397 Result.Data = Info.take();
398 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000399
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000400 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000401 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000402 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000403 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000404
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000405 return Result;
406}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000407
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000408void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
409 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
410 case Sema::TDK_Success:
411 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
412 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000413 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
414 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000415 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000416 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000417
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000418 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000419 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000420 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000421 Data = 0;
422 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000423
424 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
425 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
426 Data = 0;
427 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000428
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000429 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000430 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000431 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
432 break;
433 }
434}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000435
436TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000437OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
438 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
439 case Sema::TDK_Success:
440 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000441 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
442 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000443 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000444 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000445
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000446 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000447 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000448 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000449
450 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000451 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000452 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000453
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000454 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000455 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000456 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
457 break;
458 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000459
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000460 return TemplateParameter();
461}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000462
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000463TemplateArgumentList *
464OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
465 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
466 case Sema::TDK_Success:
467 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
468 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
469 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
470 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
471 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
472 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000473 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000474 return 0;
475
476 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
477 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000478
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000479 // Unhandled
480 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
481 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
482 break;
483 }
484
485 return 0;
486}
487
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000488const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
489 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
490 case Sema::TDK_Success:
491 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
492 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000493 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
494 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000495 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000496 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000497 return 0;
498
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000499 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000500 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000501 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000502
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000503 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000504 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000505 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
506 break;
507 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000508
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000509 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000510}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000511
512const TemplateArgument *
513OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
514 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
515 case Sema::TDK_Success:
516 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
517 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000518 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
519 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000520 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000521 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000522 return 0;
523
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000524 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000525 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000526 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
527
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000528 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000529 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000530 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
531 break;
532 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000533
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000534 return 0;
535}
536
537void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000538 inherited::clear();
539 Functions.clear();
540}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000541
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000542// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000543// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
544// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
545// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
546// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000547// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
548// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
549// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000550//
551// Example: Given the following input:
552//
553// void f(int, float); // #1
554// void f(int, int); // #2
555// int f(int, int); // #3
556//
557// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000558// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000559//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000560// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
561// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
562// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
563// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000564//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000565// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
566// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
567// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
568// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000569// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
570// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000571//
572// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
573// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
574// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
575// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000576Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000577Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
578 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000579 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000580 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000581 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
582
583 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
584 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
585 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
586
587 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
588 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
589 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
590
591 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
592 }
593
594 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
595 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
596 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
597 // function templates hide function templates with different
598 // return types or template parameter lists.
599 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
600 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
601
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000602 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000603 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
604 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
605 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
606 continue;
607 }
608
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000609 Match = *I;
610 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000611 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000612 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000613 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
614 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
615 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
616 continue;
617 }
618
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000619 Match = *I;
620 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000621 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000622 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000623 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
624 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
625 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000626 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
627 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000628 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
629 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
630 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
631 // template instantiation.
632 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000633 // (C++ 13p1):
634 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
635 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000636 Match = *I;
637 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000638 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000639 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000640
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000641 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000642}
643
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000644bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
645 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000646 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
647 // overloads.
648 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
649 return false;
650
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000651 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
652 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
653
654 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
655 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
656 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
657 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
658 return true;
659
660 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
661 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
662 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
663
664 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
665 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
666 // in the signature, they are overloads.
667
668 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
669 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
670 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
671 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
672 return false;
673
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000674 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
675 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000676
677 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
678 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
679 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
680 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
681 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
682 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000683 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000684 return true;
685
686 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
687 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
688 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
689 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
690 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
691 // signature.
692 //
693 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
694 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000695 //
696 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
697 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
698 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000699 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
700 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
701 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
702 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
703 return true;
704
705 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000706 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000707 //
708 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
709 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
710 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
711 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
712 // can be overloaded.
713 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
714 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
715 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
716 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000717 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000718 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
719 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
720 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
721 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
722 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
723 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000724 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
725 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
726 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
727 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000728 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
729 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
730 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
731 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
732 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000733
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000734 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000735 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000736
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000737 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
738 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000739}
740
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +0000741/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
742/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
743///
744/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
745/// an available function, false otherwise.
746bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
747 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
748}
749
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000750/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
751/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
752/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
753/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000754///
755/// void f(float f);
756/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
757///
758/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
759/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
760/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
761/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
762//
763/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
764/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
765/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
766/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
767/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000768///
769/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
770/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000771/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
772/// permitted.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000773///
774/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
775/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
776/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000777static ImplicitConversionSequence
778TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
779 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000780 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000781 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000782 bool CStyle,
783 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000784 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000785 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000786 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000787 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000788 return ICS;
789 }
790
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000791 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000792 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000793 return ICS;
794 }
795
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000796 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
797 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
798 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
799 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
800 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
801 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
802 // called for those cases.
803 QualType FromType = From->getType();
804 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000805 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
806 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000807 ICS.setStandard();
808 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
809 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
810 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000811
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000812 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
813 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
814 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
815 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
816 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000817
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000818 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000819 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000820 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000821
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000822 return ICS;
823 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000824
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000825 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
826 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
827 // we can perform.
828 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000829 return ICS;
830 }
831
832 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000833 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
834 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000835 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000836 AllowExplicit);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000837
838 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000839 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000840 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
841 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
842 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
843 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
844 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
845 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
846 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000847 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000848 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000849 QualType FromCanon
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000850 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
851 QualType ToCanon
852 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000853 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000854 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000855 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
856 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000857 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000858 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000859 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000860 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000861 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000862 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000863 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
864 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000865 }
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000866
867 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
868 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
869 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
870 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
871 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
872 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
873 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000874 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000875 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000876 }
John McCalle8c8cd22010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000877 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000878 ICS.setAmbiguous();
879 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
880 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
881 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
882 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
883 if (Cand->Viable)
884 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000885 } else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000886 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000887 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000888
889 return ICS;
890}
891
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000892ImplicitConversionSequence
893Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
894 bool SuppressUserConversions,
895 bool AllowExplicit,
896 bool InOverloadResolution,
897 bool CStyle,
898 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
899 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
900 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
901 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
902 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000903}
904
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000905/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000906/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000907/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
908/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
909/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000910ExprResult
911Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000912 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
913 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
914 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
915}
916
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000917ExprResult
918Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000919 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
920 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000921 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
922 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
923 = getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
924 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
925
926
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000927 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
928 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
929 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000930 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000931 /*CStyle=*/false,
932 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000933 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
934}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000935
936/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000937/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +0000938bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
939 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000940 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
941 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000942
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000943 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
944 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
945 // - a pointer
946 // - a member pointer
947 // - a block pointer
948 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
949 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
950 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
951 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
952 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
953 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
954 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
955 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
956 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
957 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
958 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
959 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
960 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
961 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
962 } else {
963 return false;
964 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000965
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000966 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
967 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
968 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
969 return false;
970 }
971
972 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
973 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
974 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
975
976 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
977 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
978 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
979
980 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000981 return true;
982}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000983
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000984/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
985/// vector conversion.
986///
987/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
988/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000989static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
990 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000991 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
992 // conversion.
993 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
994 return false;
995
996 // Identical types require no conversions.
997 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
998 return false;
999
1000 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1001 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1002 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1003 // identity conversion.
1004 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1005 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001006
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001007 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001008 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001009 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1010 return true;
1011 }
1012 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001013
1014 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1015 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1016 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1017 // same size
1018 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1019 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001020 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
1021 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001022 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1023 return true;
1024 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001025 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001026
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001027 return false;
1028}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001029
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001030/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1031/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1032/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1033/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1034/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1035/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1036/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1037/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001038static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1039 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001040 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001041 bool CStyle,
1042 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001043 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001044
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001045 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001046 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001047 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001048 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001049 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001050 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001051
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001052 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001053 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001054 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001055 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001056 return false;
1057
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001058 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001059 }
1060
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001061 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1062 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1063 // (C++ 4p1).
1064
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001065 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001066 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1067 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001068 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001069 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001070 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1071 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1072 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001073
1074 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1075 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1076 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1077 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1078 QualType resultTy;
1079 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001080 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001081 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1082 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1083 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1084 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001085 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001086
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001087 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1088 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1089 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1090 // expression.
1091 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1092 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1093 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1094 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1095 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1096 == UO_AddrOf &&
1097 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1098 const Type *ClassType
1099 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1100 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001101 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1102 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1103 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001104 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1105 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1106 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001107
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001108 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001109 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1110 FromType,
1111 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001112 } else {
1113 return false;
1114 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001115 }
John McCall154a2fd2011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001116 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1117 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1118 // be converted to a prvalue.
1119 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001120 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001121 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001122 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001123 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001124
1125 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1126 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001127 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1128 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001129 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001130 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1131 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001132 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001133
1134 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1135 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1136 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001137 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001138
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001139 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001140 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001141 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001142
1143 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1144 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1145 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1146 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001147 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1148 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001149 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001150 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001151 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001152 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001153 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001154 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001155 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001156
1157 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1158 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1159 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001160 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001161 } else {
1162 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001163 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001164 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001165 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001166
1167 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1168 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1169 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1170 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001171 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1172 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001173 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001174 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001175 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001176 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1177 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001178 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001179 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001180 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001181 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001182 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001183 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001184 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001185 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001186 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001187 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001188 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001189 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1190 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001191 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1192 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1193 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1194 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1195 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1196 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1197 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1198 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1199 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001200 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001201 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001202 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001203 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001204 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001205 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001206 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001207 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1208 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001209 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1210 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001211 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1212 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1213 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001214 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001215 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1216 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1217 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001218 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001219 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001220 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001221 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001222 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001223 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001224 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001225 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001226 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1227 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1228 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1229 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001230 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1231 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001232 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001233 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001234 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001235 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001236 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001237 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001238 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001239 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001240 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001241 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1242 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001243 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1244 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001245 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001246 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001247 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001248 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001249 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1250 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001251 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1252 InOverloadResolution,
1253 SCS, CStyle)) {
1254 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1255 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001256 } else {
1257 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001258 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001259 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001260 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001261
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001262 QualType CanonFrom;
1263 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001264 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001265 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1266 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1267 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001268 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001269 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001270 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001271 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1272 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001273 } else {
1274 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001275 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1276
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001277 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001278 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1279 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1280 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001281 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1282 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001283 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001284 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001285 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001286 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
1287 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001288 FromType = ToType;
1289 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1290 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001291 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001292 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001293
1294 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1295 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001296 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001297 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001298
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001299 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001300}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001301
1302static bool
1303IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1304 QualType &ToType,
1305 bool InOverloadResolution,
1306 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1307 bool CStyle) {
1308
1309 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1310 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1311 return false;
1312 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1313 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1314 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1315 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1316 itend = UD->field_end();
1317 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001318 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1319 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001320 ToType = it->getType();
1321 return true;
1322 }
1323 }
1324 return false;
1325}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001326
1327/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1328/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1329/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1330/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001331bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001332 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001333 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001334 if (!To) {
1335 return false;
1336 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001337
1338 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1339 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1340 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1341 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1342 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001343 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1344 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001345 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1346 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1347 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1348 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001349 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001350 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001351 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001352 }
1353
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001354 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1355 }
1356
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001357 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1358 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1359 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1360 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1361 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1362 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001363 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001364 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001365 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001366 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1367 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001368 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001369 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1370 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1371 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1372 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1373 return false;
1374
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001375 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001376 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001377 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001378 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1379 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001380 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001381
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001382 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001383 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1384 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1385 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001386 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001387 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001388 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001389 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001390 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001391 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001392 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001393 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1394 // unsigned.
David Majnemerfa01a582011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001395 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001396 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001397
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001398 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1399 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001400 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1401 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001402 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1403 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001404 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001405 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001406 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1407 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001408 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001409 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1410 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1411 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1412 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001413 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001414 }
1415 }
1416 }
1417
1418 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1419 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1420 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1421 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1422 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1423 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1424 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001425 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1426 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001427 using llvm::APSInt;
1428 if (From)
1429 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001430 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001431 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001432 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1433 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1434 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001435
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001436 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1437 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1438 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1439 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1440 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001441
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001442 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1443 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1444 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1445 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1446 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001447
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001448 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001449 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001450 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001451
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001452 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1453 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001454 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001455 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001456 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001457
1458 return false;
1459}
1460
1461/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1462/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1463/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001464bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001465 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1466 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001467 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1468 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001469 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1470 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1471 return true;
1472
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001473 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1474 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1475 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1476 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1477 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1478 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1479 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1480 return true;
1481 }
1482
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001483 return false;
1484}
1485
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001486/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1487///
1488/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1489/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001490/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001491bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001492 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001493 if (!FromComplex)
1494 return false;
1495
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001496 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001497 if (!ToComplex)
1498 return false;
1499
1500 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001501 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1502 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1503 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001504}
1505
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001506/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1507/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1508/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1509/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1510/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001511///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001512static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001513BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001514 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001515 ASTContext &Context,
1516 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001517 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1518 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1519 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001520
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001521 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1522 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001523 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001524
1525 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001526 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001527 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001528 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001529
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001530 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1531 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1532
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001533 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001534 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001535 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001536 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001537 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001538
1539 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1540 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001541 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1542 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001543 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1544 }
1545
1546 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001547 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1548 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001549
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001550 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1551 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1552 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001553}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001554
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001555static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001556 bool InOverloadResolution,
1557 ASTContext &Context) {
1558 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1559 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1560 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001561 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001562 return !InOverloadResolution;
1563
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001564 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1565 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1566 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001567}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001568
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001569/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1570/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1571/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1572/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1573/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1574/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001575///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001576/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1577/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1578/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1579/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1580/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1581/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001582/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1583/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1584/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001585bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001586 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001587 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001588 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001589 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001590 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1591 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001592 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001593
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001594 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1595 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001596 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001597 ConvertedType = ToType;
1598 return true;
1599 }
1600
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001601 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1602 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001603 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001604 ConvertedType = ToType;
1605 return true;
1606 }
1607 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1608 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001609 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001610 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001611 ConvertedType = ToType;
1612 return true;
1613 }
1614
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001615 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1616 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001617 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001618 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001619 ConvertedType = ToType;
1620 return true;
1621 }
1622
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001623 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001624 if (!ToTypePtr)
1625 return false;
1626
1627 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001628 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001629 ConvertedType = ToType;
1630 return true;
1631 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001632
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001633 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001634 // , including objective-c pointers.
1635 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001636 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
1637 !getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001638 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1639 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1640 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001641 ToType, Context);
1642 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001643 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001644 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001645 if (!FromTypePtr)
1646 return false;
1647
1648 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001649
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001650 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001651 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1652 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1653 return false;
1654
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001655 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1656 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1657 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001658 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1659 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001660 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001661 ToPointeeType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001662 ToType, Context,
1663 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001664 return true;
1665 }
1666
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001667 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +00001668 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001669 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
1670 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1671 ToPointeeType,
1672 ToType, Context);
1673 return true;
1674 }
1675
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001676 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1677 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001678 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001679 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001680 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001681 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001682 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001683 return true;
1684 }
1685
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001686 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001687 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001688 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1689 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1690 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1691 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1692 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1693 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1694 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1695 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1696 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001697 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1698 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001699 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1700 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001701 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001702 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001703 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001704 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001705 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001706 ToType, Context);
1707 return true;
1708 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001709
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00001710 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1711 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1712 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1713 ToPointeeType,
1714 ToType, Context);
1715 return true;
1716 }
1717
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001718 return false;
1719}
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001720
1721/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
1722static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
1723 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
1724
1725 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
1726 if (TQs == Qs)
1727 return T;
1728
1729 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
1730 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
1731
1732 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
1733}
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001734
1735/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1736/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1737/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001738bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001739 QualType& ConvertedType,
1740 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1741 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1742 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001743
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001744 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
1745 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
1746
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001747 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001748 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1749 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001750 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001751 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001752
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001753 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001754 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1755 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1756 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1757 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1758 return false;
1759
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001760 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001761 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001762 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001763 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001764 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001765 return true;
1766 }
1767 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001768 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001769 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001770 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001771 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001772 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001773 return true;
1774 }
1775 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1776 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1777 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001778 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1779 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1780 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1781 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1782 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1783 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001785 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1786 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001787 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001788 return true;
1789 }
1790
1791 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1792 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1793 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1794 // complain about it.
1795 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001796 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001797 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1798 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001799 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001800 return true;
1801 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001802 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001803 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001804 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001805 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001806 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001807 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001808 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001809 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001810 // to a block pointer type.
1811 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001812 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001813 return true;
1814 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001815 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001816 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001817 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001818 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001819 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001820 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001821 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001822 return true;
1823 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001824 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001825 return false;
1826
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001827 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001828 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001829 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001830 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1831 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001832 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1833 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001834 return false;
1835
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001836 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1837 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1838 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1839 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1840 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1841 // We always complain about this conversion.
1842 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001843 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001844 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001845 return true;
1846 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001847 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1848 // as in I* to id.
1849 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1850 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1851 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1852 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001853
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001854 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001855 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001856 return true;
1857 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001858
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001859 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001860 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1861 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1862 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001863 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001864 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001865 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001866 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001867 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1868 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1869 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1870 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1871 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1872 return false;
1873
1874 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1875 // function types are obviously different.
1876 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1877 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1878 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1879 return false;
1880
1881 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1882 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1883 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1884 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1885 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1886 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1887 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1888 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1889 HasObjCConversion = true;
1890 } else {
1891 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1892 return false;
1893 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001894
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001895 // Check argument types.
1896 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1897 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1898 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1899 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1900 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1901 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1902 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1903 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1904 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1905 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1906 HasObjCConversion = true;
1907 } else {
1908 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1909 return false;
1910 }
1911 }
1912
1913 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1914 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1915 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001916 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001917 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1918 return true;
1919 }
1920 }
1921
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001922 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001923}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001924
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001925/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
1926/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
1927///
1928/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
1929///
1930/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
1931///
1932/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
1933/// this conversion.
1934bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1935 QualType &ConvertedType) {
1936 if (!getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
1937 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1938 return false;
1939
1940 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
1941 QualType ToPointee;
1942 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
1943 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
1944 else
1945 return false;
1946
1947 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
1948 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
1949 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
1950 !ToQuals.withoutObjCGLifetime().empty())
1951 return false;
1952
1953 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
1954 QualType FromPointee;
1955 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
1956 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
1957 else
1958 return false;
1959
1960 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
1961 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
1962 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
1963 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
1964 return false;
1965
1966 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
1967 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
1968 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
1969 return false;
1970
1971 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
1972 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
1973 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
1974 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
1975
1976 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
1977 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
1978 bool IncompatibleObjC;
1979 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
1980 FromPointee = ToPointee;
1981 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
1982 IncompatibleObjC))
1983 return false;
1984
1985 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
1986 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
1987 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
1988 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
1989 return true;
1990}
1991
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001992bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1993 QualType& ConvertedType) {
1994 QualType ToPointeeType;
1995 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1996 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1997 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1998 else
1999 return false;
2000
2001 QualType FromPointeeType;
2002 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2003 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2004 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2005 else
2006 return false;
2007 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2008 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2009 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2010
2011 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2012 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2013 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2014 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2015
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002016 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2017 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002018
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002019 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002020 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002021
2022 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2023 // function types are obviously different.
2024 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2025 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2026 return false;
2027
2028 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2029 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2030 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2031 return false;
2032
2033 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian12834e12011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002034 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2035 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002036 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2037 } else {
2038 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2039 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
2040 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2041 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2042 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2043
2044 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2045 // OK exact match.
2046 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2047 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2048 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2049 return false;
2050 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2051 }
2052 else
2053 return false;
2054 }
2055
2056 // Check argument types.
2057 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2058 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2059 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2060 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2061 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2062 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2063 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2064 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2065 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2066 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2067 return false;
2068 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2069 } else
2070 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2071 return false;
2072 }
2073 ConvertedType = ToType;
2074 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002075}
2076
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002077/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2078/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2079/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2080/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002081bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002082 const FunctionProtoType *NewType) {
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002083 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
2084 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
2085 NewType->arg_type_begin());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002086
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002087 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2088 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2089 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2090 QualType ToType = (*O);
2091 QualType FromType = (*N);
2092 if (ToType != FromType) {
2093 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2094 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002095 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2096 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2097 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2098 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002099 continue;
2100 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002101 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2102 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002103 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002104 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
2105 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
2106 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002107 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002108 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002109 }
2110 }
2111 return true;
2112}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002113
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002114/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2115/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002116/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002117/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2118/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2119/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002120bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002121 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002122 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002123 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002124 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002125 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002126
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002127 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2128
Chandler Carruthffab8732011-04-09 07:32:05 +00002129 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2130 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
2131 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
2132 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
Chandler Carruth66a7b042011-04-09 07:48:17 +00002133 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2134 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00002135
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002136 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2137 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002138 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2139 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002140
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002141 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2142 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002143 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2144 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002145 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2146 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002147 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002148 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002149 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002150
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002151 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002152 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002153 }
2154 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002155 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2156 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2157 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2158 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002159 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2160 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2161 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002162 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002163 return false;
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002164 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2165 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2166 } else {
2167 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002168 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002169 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2170 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2171 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002172 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002173
2174 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2175 // reasons.
2176 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2177 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2178
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002179 return false;
2180}
2181
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002182/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2183/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2184/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2185/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2186/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2187bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002188 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002189 bool InOverloadResolution,
2190 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002191 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002192 if (!ToTypePtr)
2193 return false;
2194
2195 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002196 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2197 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2198 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002199 ConvertedType = ToType;
2200 return true;
2201 }
2202
2203 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002204 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002205 if (!FromTypePtr)
2206 return false;
2207
2208 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2209 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2210 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2211 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002212
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002213 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2214 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2215 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002216 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2217 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2218 return true;
2219 }
2220
2221 return false;
2222}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002223
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002224/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2225/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002226/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002227/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2228/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2229/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002230bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002231 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002232 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002233 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002234 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002235 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002236 if (!FromPtrType) {
2237 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002238 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002239 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002240 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002241 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002242 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002243 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002244
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002245 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002246 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2247 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002248
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002249 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2250 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002251
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002252 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2253 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2254 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002255
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002256 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002257 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002258 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2259 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2260 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2261 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002262
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002263 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2264 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002265 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2266 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2267 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2268 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002269 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002270
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002271 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002272 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2273 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2274 << From->getSourceRange();
2275 return true;
2276 }
2277
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002278 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002279 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2280 Paths.front(),
2281 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002282
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002283 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002284 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002285 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002286 return false;
2287}
2288
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002289/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2290/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2291/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002292///
2293/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2294/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2295/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002296bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002297Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002298 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002299 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2300 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002301 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2302
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002303 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2304 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002305 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002306 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002307
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002308 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2309 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2310 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2311 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002312 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002313 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002314 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2315 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2316 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002317 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002318 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2319 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002320 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002321
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002322 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2323 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2324
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002325 // Objective-C ARC:
2326 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2327 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2328 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2329 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2330 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2331 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2332 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2333 } else {
2334 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2335 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2336 return false;
2337 }
2338 }
2339
Douglas Gregorf30053d2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002340 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2341 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2342 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2343 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2344 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2345 }
2346
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002347 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2348 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002349 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002350 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002351
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002352 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2353 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002354 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002355 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002356 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002357
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002358 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2359 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002360 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002361 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002362 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002363
2364 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2365 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2366 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2367 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2368 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002369 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002370}
2371
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002372/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2373/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2374/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2375/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2376/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2377/// false and User is unspecified.
2378///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002379/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2380/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2381/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002382static OverloadingResult
2383IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2384 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2385 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2386 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002387 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2388 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2389
2390 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2391 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002392 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002393 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2394 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2395 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2396 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2397 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2398 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2399 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2400 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002401 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002402 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002403 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002404 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2405
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7a6f2a32011-04-22 17:45:37 +00002406 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag());
2407 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2408 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2409 // to try to recover.
2410 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002411 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2412 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2413 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002414 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002415 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002416 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002417 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2418 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2419
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002420 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2421 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2422 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002423 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002424 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002425 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002426 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2427 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002428 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002429
Fariborz Jahanian11a8e952009-08-06 17:22:51 +00002430 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssond20e7952009-08-28 16:57:08 +00002431 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002432 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002433 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2434 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002435 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002436 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2437 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002438 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002439 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2440 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002441 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2442 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2443 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2444 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002445 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002446 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002447 }
2448 }
2449
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002450 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2451 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002452 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2453 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002454 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002455 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002456 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002457 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002458 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2459 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002460 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002461 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002462 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002463 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002464 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2465 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002466 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2467 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2468 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2469
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002470 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2471 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002472 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2473 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002474 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002475 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002476
2477 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2478 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002479 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2480 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2481 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002482 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002483 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2484 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002485 }
2486 }
2487 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002488 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002489
2490 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002491 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002492 case OR_Success:
2493 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2494 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2495 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002496 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2497
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002498 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2499 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2500 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2501 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2502 // the argument of the constructor.
2503 //
2504 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2505 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2506 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2507 else {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002508 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002509 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002510 }
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002511 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00002512 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002513 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2514 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2515 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2516 return OR_Success;
2517 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2518 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002519 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
2520
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002521 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2522 //
2523 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2524 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2525 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2526 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2527 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2528 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00002529 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002530 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002531
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002532 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2533 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2534 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2535 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2536 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2537 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2538 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2539 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2540 // 13.3.3.1).
2541 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2542 return OR_Success;
2543 } else {
2544 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002545 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002546 }
2547
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002548 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2549 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2550 case OR_Deleted:
2551 // No conversion here! We're done.
2552 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002553
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002554 case OR_Ambiguous:
2555 return OR_Ambiguous;
2556 }
2557
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002558 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002559}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002560
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002561bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002562Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002563 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002564 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002565 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002566 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002567 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002568 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2569 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2570 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2571 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2572 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2573 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2574 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2575 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2576 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002577 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002578 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002579 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002580}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002581
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002582/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2583/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2584/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002585static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2586CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2587 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2588 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002589{
2590 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2591 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2592 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2593 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2594 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2595 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2596 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2597 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002598 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002599 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2600 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2601 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2602 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2603 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002604 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2605 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2606 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2607 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002608
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002609 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2610 // the same kind.
2611 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2612 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2613
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002614 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2615 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2616 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002617 if (ICS1.isStandard())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002618 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002619 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002620 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2621 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2622 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2623 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2624 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2625 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002626 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002627 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002628 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2629 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002630 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2631 }
2632
2633 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2634}
2635
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002636static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2637 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2638 Qualifiers Quals;
2639 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002640 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002641 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002642
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002643 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2644}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002645
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002646// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2647// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2648static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2649compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2650 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2651 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2652 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2653 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2654
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002655 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002656 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor377c1092011-06-05 06:15:20 +00002657 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2658 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2659 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2660 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002661
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002662 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2663 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2664 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2665 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2666 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2667 else
2668 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002669 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002670 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2671
2672 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2673 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2674 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2675 }
2676
2677 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2678 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2679 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2680 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2681
2682 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2683 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2684 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2685 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002686
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002687 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2688}
2689
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002690/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
2691/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
2692static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
2693 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
2694 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2695 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2696 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002697 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002698 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002699 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002700 // reference*.
2701 //
2702 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
2703 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
2704 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
2705 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
2706 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00002707 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
2708 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
2709 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002710
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002711 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
2712 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
2713 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
2714 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
2715}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002716
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002717/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2718/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2719/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002720static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2721CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2722 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2723 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002724{
2725 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2726 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2727
2728 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2729 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2730 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2731 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2732 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002733 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002734 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002735 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002736
2737 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2738 // defined below), or, if not that,
2739 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2740 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2741 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2742 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2743 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2744 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002745
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002746 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2747 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2748 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002749
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002750 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2751 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2752 // that is such a conversion.
2753 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2754 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2755 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2756 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2757
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002758 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2759 //
2760 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002761 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2762 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2763 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002764 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002765 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002766 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002767 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002768 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2769 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2770 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002771 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2772 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002773 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2774 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2775 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002776 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002777 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002778 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002779 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
2780 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002781 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2782 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2783 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002784 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2785 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002786
2787 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2788 // conversion, if we need to.
2789 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002790 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002791 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002792 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002793
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002794 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2795 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002796
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002797 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002798 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002799 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002800 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2801
2802 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2803 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002804 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
2805 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2806 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
2807 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2808 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
2809 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
2810 FromObjCPtr2);
2811 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
2812 FromObjCPtr1);
2813 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
2814 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2815 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2816 }
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002817 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002818 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002819
2820 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2821 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002822 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002823 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002824 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002825
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002826 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002827 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
2828 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
2829 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2830 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
2831 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002832
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002833 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2834 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2835 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2836 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2837 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2838 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002839 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2840 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002841 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2842 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002843 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002844 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2845 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002846 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002847 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
2848 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
2849 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
2850 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
2851 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
2852 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2853 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2854 }
2855
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002856 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2857 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002858 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002859 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002860 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002861 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002862 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2863 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2864 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002865 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002866 }
2867 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002868
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00002869 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
2870 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
2871 // is between types of the same size.
2872 // For example:
2873 // void f(float);
2874 // void f(int);
2875 // int main {
2876 // long a;
2877 // f(a);
2878 // }
2879 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
2880 // as clang will do in standard mode.
2881 if (S.getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode &&
2882 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
2883 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
2884 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
2885 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
2886 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2887
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002888 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2889}
2890
2891/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2892/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002893/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2894ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002895CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2896 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2897 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002898 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002899 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2900 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2901 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2902 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2903 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2904 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2905 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2906 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2907
2908 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2909 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002910 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2911 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002912 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2913 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002914 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002915 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2916 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002917
2918 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2919 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002920 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002921 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2922
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002923 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2924 // for comparison.
2925 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002926 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002927 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002928 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002929
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002930 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002931 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002932
2933 // Objective-C++ ARC:
2934 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
2935 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
2936 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
2937 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
2938 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2939 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2940 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2941 }
2942
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002943 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002944 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2945 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2946 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002947 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002948 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2949 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2950 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2951 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2952 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2953 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2954 // about how the sequences rank.
2955 ;
2956 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2957 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2958 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2959 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2960 // qualifiers.
2961 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002962
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002963 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2964 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2965 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2966 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2967 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2968 // qualifiers.
2969 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002970
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002971 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2972 } else {
2973 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2974 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2975 }
2976
2977 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002978 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002979 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002980 }
2981
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002982 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2983 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2984 switch (Result) {
2985 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002986 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002987 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2988 break;
2989
2990 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2991 break;
2992
2993 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002994 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002995 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2996 break;
2997 }
2998
2999 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003000}
3001
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003002/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3003/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003004/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3005/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3006/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003007ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003008CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3009 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3010 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003011 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003012 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003013 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003014 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003015
3016 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3017 // conversion, if we need to.
3018 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003019 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003020 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003021 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003022
3023 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003024 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3025 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3026 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3027 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003028
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003029 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003030 //
3031 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3032 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003033 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003034 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003035 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003036 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3037 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3038 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3039 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003040 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003041 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003042 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003043 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003044 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003045 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003046 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003047 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003048
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003049 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003050 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003051 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003052 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003053 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003054 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3055 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003056
3057 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3058 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003059 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003060 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003061 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003062 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003063 }
3064 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3065 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3066 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3067 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3068 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3069 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3070 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3071 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3072 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3073 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3074
3075 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3076 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3077 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3078 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3079 // Objective-C pointer types.
3080 bool FromAssignLeft
3081 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3082 bool FromAssignRight
3083 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3084 bool ToAssignLeft
3085 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3086 bool ToAssignRight
3087 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3088
3089 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3090 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3091 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3092 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3093 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3094 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3095 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3096 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3097
3098 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3099 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3100 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3101 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3102 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3103 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3104
3105 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3106 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3107 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3108 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3109 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3110 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3111 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3112 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3113
3114 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3115 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3116 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3117 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3118 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3119 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003120
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003121 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3122 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3123 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3124 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3125 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3126 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3127
3128 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3129 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3130 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3131 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3132 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003133 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003134 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003135
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003136 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003137 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3138 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3139 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003140 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003141 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003142 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003143 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003144 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003145 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003146 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003147 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3148 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3149 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3150 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3151 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3152 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3153 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3154 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3155 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003156 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003157 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003158 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003159 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003160 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003161 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3162 }
3163 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3164 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003165 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003166 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003167 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003168 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3169 }
3170 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003171
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003172 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003173 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003174 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3175 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3176 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003177 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3178 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3179 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003180 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003181 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003182 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3183 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003184
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003185 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003186 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3187 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3188 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003189 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3190 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3191 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003192 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003193 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003194 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3195 }
3196 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003197
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003198 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3199}
3200
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003201/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3202/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3203/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3204/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3205/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3206/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3207/// type being initialized.
3208Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3209Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3210 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003211 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003212 bool &ObjCConversion,
3213 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003214 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3215 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3216 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3217
3218 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3219 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3220 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3221 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3222 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3223
3224 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3225 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3226 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3227 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003228 DerivedToBase = false;
3229 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003230 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003231 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3232 // Nothing to do.
3233 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003234 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3235 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003236 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3237 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3238 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3239 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003240 else
3241 return Ref_Incompatible;
3242
3243 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3244 // least).
3245
3246 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3247 // for comparison.
3248 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3249 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3250 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3251 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3252
3253 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3254 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3255 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3256 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3257 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3258 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3259 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003260 //
3261 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3262 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3263 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3264 // space 2.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003265 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3266 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3267 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3268 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3269 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3270 }
3271
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003272 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003273 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003274 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003275 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3276 else
3277 return Ref_Related;
3278}
3279
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003280/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003281/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3282static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003283FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3284 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3285 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3286 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003287 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3288 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3289 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3290
3291 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3292 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3293 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3294 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3295 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3296 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3297 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3298 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3299 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3300
3301 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3302 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3303 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3304 if (ConvTemplate)
3305 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3306 else
3307 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3308
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003309 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003310 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3311 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3312 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003313
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003314 if (AllowRvalues) {
3315 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3316 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003317 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003318 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003319 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3320 DeclLoc,
3321 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3322 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3323 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003324 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003325 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003326 continue;
3327 } else {
3328 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3329 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3330 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3331
3332 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3333 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3334 if (!RefType ||
3335 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3336 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3337 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003338 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003339
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003340 if (ConvTemplate)
3341 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003342 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003343 else
3344 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003345 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003346 }
3347
3348 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003349 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003350 case OR_Success:
3351 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3352 //
3353 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3354 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3355 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3356 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3357 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3358 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3359 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3360 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3361 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3362 return false;
3363
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003364 if (Best->Function)
3365 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003366 ICS.setUserDefined();
3367 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3368 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3369 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003370 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003371 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3372 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3373 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3374 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3375 return true;
3376
3377 case OR_Ambiguous:
3378 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3379 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3380 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3381 if (Cand->Viable)
3382 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3383 return true;
3384
3385 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3386 case OR_Deleted:
3387 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3388 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3389 return false;
3390 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003391
Eric Christopheraba9fb22010-06-30 18:36:32 +00003392 return false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003393}
3394
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003395/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3396/// initialization.
3397static ImplicitConversionSequence
3398TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
3399 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3400 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003401 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003402 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3403
3404 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3405 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3406 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3407
3408 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3409 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3410
3411 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3412 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3413 // type of the resulting function.
3414 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3415 DeclAccessPair Found;
3416 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3417 false, Found))
3418 T2 = Fn->getType();
3419 }
3420
3421 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3422 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3423 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003424 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003425 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003426 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003427 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003428 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003429 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003430
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003431
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003432 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003433 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3434 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3435
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003436 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003437 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003438 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3439 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3440 //
3441 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3442 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3443 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003444 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003445 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3446 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3447 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3448 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3449 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3450 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
3451 ICS.setStandard();
3452 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003453 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3454 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3455 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003456 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3457 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3458 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3459 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3460 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3461 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3462 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003463 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3464 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3465 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003466 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003467 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003468 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003469
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003470 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
3471 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
3472 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
3473 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003474 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003475 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003476
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003477 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
3478 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
3479 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
3480 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
3481 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
3482 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
3483 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
3484 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003485 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003486 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003487 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3488 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
3489 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003490 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003491 }
3492 }
3493
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003494 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3495 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003496 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003497 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003498 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3499 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3500 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3501 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3502 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3503 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3504 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003505 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3506 // go together.
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003507 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003508 return ICS;
3509
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003510 // -- If the initializer expression
3511 //
3512 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003513 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003514 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
3515 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
3516 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
3517 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
3518 ICS.setStandard();
3519 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003520 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003521 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3522 : ICK_Identity;
3523 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3524 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3525 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3526 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3527 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3528 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3529 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
3530 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
3531 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
3532 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
3533 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003534 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
3535 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003536 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003537 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3538 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003539 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003540 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003541 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003542 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003543 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003544 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003545
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003546 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
3547 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003548 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
3549 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003550 // "cv3 T3",
3551 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003552 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003553 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003554 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003555 // class subobject).
3556 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003557 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003558 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3559 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3560 AllowExplicit)) {
3561 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
3562 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
3563 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
3564 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003565 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003566 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
3567 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3568
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00003569 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00003570 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003571
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003572 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3573 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
3574 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3575 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3576 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3577 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3578 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3579 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3580 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3581 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3582 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3583 // initialization fails.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003584 //
3585 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
3586 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
3587 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
3588 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
3589 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3590 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3591 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3592 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3593 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
3594 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003595 }
3596
3597 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3598 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3599 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3600 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3601 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3602 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3603 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3604 return ICS;
3605
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003606 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
3607 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
3608 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
3609 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
3610 return ICS;
3611
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003612 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003613 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3614 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3615 // required to convert the argument expression to the
3616 // underlying type of the reference according to
3617 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3618 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3619 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3620 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3621 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003622 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3623 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003624 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003625 /*CStyle=*/false,
3626 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003627
3628 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3629 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3630 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003631 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3632 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3633 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003634 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003635 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003636 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3637 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor3ec79102011-08-15 13:59:46 +00003638 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3639 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3640 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
3641 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
3642 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003643 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003644
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003645 return ICS;
3646}
3647
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003648/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3649/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3650/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3651/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003652/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00003653/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003654static ImplicitConversionSequence
3655TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003656 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003657 bool InOverloadResolution,
3658 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003659 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003660 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003661 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3662 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003663 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003664
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003665 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3666 SuppressUserConversions,
3667 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003668 InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003669 /*CStyle=*/false,
3670 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003671}
3672
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00003673static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
3674 const CanQualType ToQTy,
3675 Sema &S,
3676 SourceLocation Loc,
3677 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
3678 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
3679 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
3680 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
3681
3682 return !ICS.isBad();
3683}
3684
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003685/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3686/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3687/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003688static ImplicitConversionSequence
3689TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003690 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003691 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3692 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3693 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003694 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3695 // const volatile object.
3696 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3697 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003698 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003699
3700 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3701 // to exit early.
3702 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003703
3704 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00003705 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003706 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003707 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3708
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003709 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
3710 // better have an lvalue.
3711 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
3712 }
3713
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003714 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003715
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003716 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003717 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003718 // parameter is
3719 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003720 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
3721 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
3722 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003723 // ref-qualifier
3724 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003725 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003726 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
3727 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003728 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003729 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003730 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3731 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3732 // non-constant references.
3733
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003734 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003735 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003736 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003737 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003738 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003739 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3740 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003741 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003742 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003743
3744 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3745 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003746 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003747 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3748 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3749 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003750 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003751 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003752 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003753 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3754 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003755 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003756 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003757
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003758 // Check the ref-qualifier.
3759 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
3760 case RQ_None:
3761 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
3762 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003763
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003764 case RQ_LValue:
3765 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
3766 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003767 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003768 ImplicitParamType);
3769 return ICS;
3770 }
3771 break;
3772
3773 case RQ_RValue:
3774 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
3775 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003776 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003777 ImplicitParamType);
3778 return ICS;
3779 }
3780 break;
3781 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003782
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003783 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003784 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003785 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3786 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003787 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003788 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003789 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3790 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003791 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003792 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003793 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
3794 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
3795 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003796 return ICS;
3797}
3798
3799/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3800/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3801/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003802ExprResult
3803Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003804 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003805 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003806 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003807 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003808 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003809 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003810
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003811 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003812 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003813 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3814 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003815 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003816 } else {
3817 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3818 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003819 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003820 }
3821
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003822 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3823 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003824 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003825 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
3826 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003827 if (ICS.isBad()) {
3828 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
3829 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
3830 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
3831 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
3832 if (CVR) {
3833 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3834 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
3835 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
3836 << From->getSourceRange();
3837 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3838 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003839 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003840 }
3841 }
3842
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003843 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003844 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003845 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003846 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003847
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003848 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3849 ExprResult FromRes =
3850 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
3851 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
3852 return ExprError();
3853 From = FromRes.take();
3854 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003855
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003856 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003857 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
3858 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue).take();
3859 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003860}
3861
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003862/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3863/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003864static ImplicitConversionSequence
3865TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003866 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003867 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003868 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3869 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003870 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003871 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003872 /*CStyle=*/false,
3873 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003874}
3875
3876/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3877/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003878ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003879 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003880 if (!ICS.isBad())
3881 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003882
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003883 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003884 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3885 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003886 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003887 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003888}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003889
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00003890/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
3891/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
3892/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
3893static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
3894 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3895 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
3896 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
3897 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
3898 }
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003899}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003900
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00003901/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
3902/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
3903static ImplicitConversionSequence
3904TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
3905 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
3906 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
3907 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
3908 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
3909 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3910 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3911 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
3912 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3913 /*CStyle=*/false,
3914 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
3915
3916 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
3917 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
3918 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
3919 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
3920 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
3921 break;
3922
3923 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
3924 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
3925 break;
3926
3927 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
3928 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
3929 break;
3930 }
3931
3932 return ICS;
3933}
3934
3935/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
3936/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
3937ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003938 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00003939 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
3940 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003941 if (!ICS.isBad())
3942 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003943 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003944}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003945
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003946/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003947/// enumeration type.
3948///
3949/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3950/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3951/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3952///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003953/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3954/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003955///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003956/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3957///
3958/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3959/// have integral or enumeration type.
3960///
3961/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3962/// incomplete class type.
3963///
3964/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3965/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3966/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3967///
3968/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3969/// showing which conversion was picked.
3970///
3971/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3972/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3973///
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003974/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003975/// usable conversion function.
3976///
3977/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3978/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3979///
3980/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3981/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003982ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003983Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003984 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3985 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3986 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3987 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3988 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003989 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3990 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003991 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3992 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003993 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003994
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003995 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3996 QualType T = From->getType();
3997 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003998 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003999
4000 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
4001
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004002 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004003 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
4004 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
4005 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4006 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
4007 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004008 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004009 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004010
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004011 // We must have a complete class type.
4012 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004013 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004014
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004015 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4016 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
4017 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
4018 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4019 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004020
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004021 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004022 E = Conversions->end();
4023 I != E;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004024 ++I) {
4025 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4026 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
4027 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4028 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
4029 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
4030 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
4031 else
4032 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
4033 }
4034 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004035
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004036 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
4037 case 0:
4038 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
4039 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
4040 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4041 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004042
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004043 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
4044 // conversion; use it.
4045 QualType ConvTy
4046 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4047 std::string TypeStr;
4048 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004049
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004050 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
4051 << T << ConvTy
4052 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
4053 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
4054 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
4055 ")");
4056 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
4057 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004058
4059 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004060 // explicit conversion function.
4061 if (isSFINAEContext())
4062 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004063
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004064 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004065 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion);
4066 if (Result.isInvalid())
4067 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004068
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004069 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004070 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004071
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004072 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
4073 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004074
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004075 case 1: {
4076 // Apply this conversion.
4077 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
4078 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004079
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004080 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4081 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
4082 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004083 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004084 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
4085 if (isSFINAEContext())
4086 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004087
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004088 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
4089 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
4090 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004091
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004092 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004093 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004094 if (Result.isInvalid())
4095 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004096
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004097 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004098 break;
4099 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004100
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004101 default:
4102 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
4103 << T << From->getSourceRange();
4104 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
4105 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
4106 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
4107 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4108 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
4109 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
4110 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004111 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004112 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004113
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00004114 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004115 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
4116 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004117
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004118 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004119}
4120
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004121/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004122/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
4123/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
4124/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00004125///
4126/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
4127/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
4128/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004129void
4130Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004131 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004132 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004133 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00004134 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00004135 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004136 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004137 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004138 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004139 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004140 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004141
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004142 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004143 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
4144 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
4145 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
4146 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
4147 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004148 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
4149 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
4150 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004151 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004152 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004153 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004154 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004155 return;
4156 }
4157 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
4158 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004159 }
4160
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00004161 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004162 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00004163
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004164 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004165 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004166
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00004167 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
4168 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
4169 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
4170 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
4171 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004172 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00004173 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00004174 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
4175 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00004176 return;
4177 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004178
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004179 // Add this candidate
4180 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4181 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004182 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004183 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004184 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004185 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004186 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004187 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004188
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004189 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4190
4191 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4192 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4193 // list (8.3.5).
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004194 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00004195 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004196 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004197 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004198 return;
4199 }
4200
4201 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4202 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4203 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4204 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4205 // exactly m parameters.
4206 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00004207 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004208 // Not enough arguments.
4209 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004210 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004211 return;
4212 }
4213
4214 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4215 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004216 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
4217 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4218 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4219 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4220 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4221 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4222 // parameter of F.
4223 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004224 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004225 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004226 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004227 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
4228 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4229 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004230 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
4231 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004232 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004233 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004234 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004235 } else {
4236 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4237 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4238 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004239 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004240 }
4241 }
4242}
4243
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004244/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
4245/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00004246void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004247 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4248 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4249 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00004250 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004251 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
4252 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004253 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004254 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004255 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004256 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004257 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004258 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
4259 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004260 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004261 SuppressUserConversions);
4262 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004263 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004264 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4265 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004266 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004267 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004268 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004269 Args[0]->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004270 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
4271 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004272 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00004273 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004274 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004275 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004276 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004277 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
4278 SuppressUserConversions);
4279 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00004280 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004281}
4282
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004283/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
4284/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004285void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004286 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004287 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004288 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4289 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004290 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004291 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004292 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004293
4294 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
4295 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004296
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004297 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
4298 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4299 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004300 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
4301 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004302 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004303 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004304 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004305 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004306 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004307 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004308 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004309 }
4310}
4311
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004312/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
4313/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
4314/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
4315/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
4316/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
4317/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004318/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004319void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004320Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004321 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004322 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004323 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004324 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004325 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004326 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004327 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004328 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004329 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
4330 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004331
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004332 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
4333 return;
4334
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004335 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004336 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004337
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004338 // Add this candidate
4339 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4340 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004341 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004342 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004343 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004344 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004345 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004346
4347 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4348
4349 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4350 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4351 // list (8.3.5).
4352 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4353 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004354 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004355 return;
4356 }
4357
4358 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4359 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4360 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4361 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4362 // exactly m parameters.
4363 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
4364 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
4365 // Not enough arguments.
4366 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004367 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004368 return;
4369 }
4370
4371 Candidate.Viable = true;
4372 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4373
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004374 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004375 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
4376 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
4377 else {
4378 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
4379 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004380 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004381 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4382 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004383 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004384 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004385 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004386 return;
4387 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004388 }
4389
4390 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4391 // arguments.
4392 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4393 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4394 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4395 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4396 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4397 // parameter of F.
4398 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004399 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004400 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004401 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004402 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
4403 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4404 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004405 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004406 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004407 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004408 break;
4409 }
4410 } else {
4411 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4412 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4413 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004414 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004415 }
4416 }
4417}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004418
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004419/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
4420/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
4421/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004422void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004423Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004424 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004425 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004426 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004427 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004428 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004429 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004430 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004431 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004432 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
4433 return;
4434
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004435 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004436 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004437 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004438 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004439 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4440 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4441 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4442 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4443 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004444 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004445 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4446 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004447 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004448 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004449 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4450 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4451 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4452 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
4453 Candidate.Viable = false;
4454 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4455 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4456 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004457 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004458 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004459 Info);
4460 return;
4461 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004462
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004463 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4464 // deduction as a candidate.
4465 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004466 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004467 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004468 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004469 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4470 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004471}
4472
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004473/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
4474/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
4475/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004476void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004477Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004478 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004479 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004480 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4481 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004482 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004483 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4484 return;
4485
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004486 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004487 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004488 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004489 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004490 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4491 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4492 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4493 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4494 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004495 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004496 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4497 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004498 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004499 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004500 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4501 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004502 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004503 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4504 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004505 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004506 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4507 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004508 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004509 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004510 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004511 return;
4512 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004513
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004514 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4515 // deduction as a candidate.
4516 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004517 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004518 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004519}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004520
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004521/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004522/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004523/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004524/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004525/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
4526/// conversion function produces).
4527void
4528Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004529 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004530 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004531 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4532 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004533 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
4534 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004535 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004536 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4537 return;
4538
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004539 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004540 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004541
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004542 // Add this candidate
4543 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4544 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004545 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004546 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004547 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004548 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004549 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004550 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004551 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004552 Candidate.Viable = true;
4553 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004554 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004555
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004556 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004557 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
4558 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004559 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004560 //
4561 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4562 // object parameter.
4563 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
4564 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
4565 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
4566 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
4567 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004568
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004569 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004570 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
4571 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004572 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004573
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004574 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004575 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004576 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004577 return;
4578 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004579
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004580 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004581 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
4582 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
4583 QualType FromCanon
4584 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
4585 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
4586 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
4587 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004588 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004589 return;
4590 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004591
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004592 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
4593 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
4594 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
4595 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
4596 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
4597 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
4598 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
4599 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004600 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004601 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004602 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
4603 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004604 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00004605 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004606
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00004607 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
4608 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00004609 Candidate.Viable = false;
4610 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4611 return;
4612 }
4613
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00004614 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004615
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004616 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00004617 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
4618 // allocator).
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00004619 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004620 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00004621 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004622 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004623 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004624 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004625 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4626 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004627
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004628 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004629 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4630 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004631
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004632 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
4633 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004634 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004635 // shall have exact match rank.
4636 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
4637 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
4638 Candidate.Viable = false;
4639 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
4640 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004641
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004642 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4643 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
4644 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
4645 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
4646 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004647 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004648 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
4649 Candidate.Viable = false;
4650 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4651 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004652 break;
4653
4654 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4655 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004656 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004657 break;
4658
4659 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004660 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004661 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
4662 }
4663}
4664
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004665/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
4666/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
4667/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
4668/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
4669/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004670void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004671Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004672 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004673 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004674 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4675 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4676 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4677 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
4678
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004679 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4680 return;
4681
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004682 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004683 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4684 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004685 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004686 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004687 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4688 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4689 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4690 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4691 Candidate.Viable = false;
4692 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4693 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4694 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004695 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004696 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004697 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004698 return;
4699 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004700
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004701 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4702 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4703 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004704 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004705 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004706}
4707
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004708/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4709/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4710/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4711/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4712/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4713void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004714 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004715 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004716 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004717 Expr *Object,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004718 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004719 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004720 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4721 return;
4722
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004723 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004724 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004725
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004726 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4727 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004728 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004729 Candidate.Function = 0;
4730 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4731 Candidate.Viable = true;
4732 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004733 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004734 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004735 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004736
4737 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4738 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004739 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004740 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004741 Object->Classify(Context),
4742 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004743 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004744 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004745 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004746 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004747 return;
4748 }
4749
4750 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4751 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4752 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004753 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004754 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00004755 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004756 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004757 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004758 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004759 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4760 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4761
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004762 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004763 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4764
4765 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4766 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4767 // list (8.3.5).
4768 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4769 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004770 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004771 return;
4772 }
4773
4774 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4775 // we have enough arguments.
4776 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4777 // Not enough arguments.
4778 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004779 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004780 return;
4781 }
4782
4783 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4784 // arguments.
4785 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4786 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4787 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4788 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4789 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4790 // parameter of F.
4791 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004792 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004793 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004794 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004795 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4796 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4797 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004798 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004799 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004800 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004801 break;
4802 }
4803 } else {
4804 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4805 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4806 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004807 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004808 }
4809 }
4810}
4811
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004812/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
4813/// member functions.
4814///
4815/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
4816/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
4817/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
4818/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
4819/// [over.match.oper]).
4820void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
4821 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4822 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4823 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4824 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004825 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
4826
4827 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4828 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
4829 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
4830 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
4831 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
4832 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
4833 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
4834 // constructed as follows:
4835 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004836
4837 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
4838 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
4839 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
4840 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004841 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004842 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004843 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004844 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004845
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00004846 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
4847 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
4848 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
4849
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004850 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004851 OperEnd = Operators.end();
4852 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004853 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004854 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004855 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004856 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004857 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004858 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004859}
4860
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004861/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
4862/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
4863/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004864/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
4865/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004866/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
4867/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
4868/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004869void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004870 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004871 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004872 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
4873 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004874 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004875 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004876
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004877 // Add this candidate
4878 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4879 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004880 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004881 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00004882 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004883 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004884 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
4885 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4886 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
4887
4888 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4889 // arguments.
4890 Candidate.Viable = true;
4891 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004892 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004893 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004894 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
4895 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
4896 // left operand are restricted as follows:
4897 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
4898 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
4899 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004900 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004901 //
4902 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4903 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4904 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4905 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004906 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004907 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004908 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004909 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4910 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004911 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004912 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004913 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004914 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004915 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4916 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4917 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004918 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004919 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004920 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004921 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004922 break;
4923 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004924 }
4925}
4926
4927/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4928/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4929/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4930/// enumeration types.
4931class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4932 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004933 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004934
4935 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4936 /// built-in candidates.
4937 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4938
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004939 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4940 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4941 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4942
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004943 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4944 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4945 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4946
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004947 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004948 /// candidates.
4949 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004950
4951 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
4952 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
4953
4954 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
4955 /// were present in the candidate set.
4956 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
4957
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00004958 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
4959 /// candidate set.
4960 bool HasNullPtrType;
4961
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004962 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4963 /// candidate type set.
4964 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004965
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004966 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4967 ASTContext &Context;
4968
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004969 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4970 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004971 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004972
4973public:
4974 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004975 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004976
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004977 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004978 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
4979 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00004980 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004981 SemaRef(SemaRef),
4982 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004983
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004984 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004985 SourceLocation Loc,
4986 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004987 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4988 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004989
4990 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4991 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4992
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004993 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004994 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4995
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004996 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4997 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4998
4999 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
5000 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
5001
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005002 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
5003 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
5004
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005005 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005006 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005007
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005008 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
5009 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005010
5011 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
5012 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005013 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005014};
5015
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005016/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005017/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5018/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5019/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5020/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5021/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5022/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005023///
5024/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005025bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005026BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
5027 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005028
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005029 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005030 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005031 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005032
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005033 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005034 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00005035 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005036 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00005037 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005038 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00005039 buildObjCPtr = true;
5040 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005041 else
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005042 llvm_unreachable("type was not a pointer type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005043 }
5044 else
5045 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005046
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00005047 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
5048 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
5049 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
5050 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
5051 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
5052 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005053 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00005054 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00005055 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005056 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
5057 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005058
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005059 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
5060 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
5061 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005062 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
5063 // in the types.
5064 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
5065 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005066 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00005067 if (!buildObjCPtr)
5068 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
5069 else
5070 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005071 }
5072
5073 return true;
5074}
5075
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005076/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
5077/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5078/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5079/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5080/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5081/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5082/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005083///
5084/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005085bool
5086BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
5087 QualType Ty) {
5088 // Insert this type.
5089 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
5090 return false;
5091
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005092 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
5093 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005094
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005095 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00005096 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
5097 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
5098 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
5099 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
5100 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
5101 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005102 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
5103
5104 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
5105 // qualifiers.
5106 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
5107 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
5108 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005109
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005110 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005111 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
5112 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005113 }
5114
5115 return true;
5116}
5117
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005118/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
5119/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005120/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
5121/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005122/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
5123/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
5124/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
5125/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005126void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005127BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005128 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005129 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005130 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
5131 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005132 // Only deal with canonical types.
5133 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
5134
5135 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
5136 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005137 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005138 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
5139
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005140 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
5141 if (Ty->isArrayType())
5142 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
5143
5144 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005145 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005146
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005147 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
5148 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
5149 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
5150
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005151 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
5152 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
5153 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
5154
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005155 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
5156 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
5157 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005158 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
5159 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005160 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005161 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005162 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
5163 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
5164 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
5165 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005166 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005167 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005168 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005169 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005170 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
5171 // extension.
5172 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005173 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005174 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
5175 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005176 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
5177 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
5178 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
5179 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005180
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005181 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
5182 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
5183 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
5184 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
5185 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
5186 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
5187 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5188 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005189
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005190 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
5191 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
5192 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
5193 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005194
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005195 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5196 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
5197 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
5198 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005199 }
5200 }
5201 }
5202}
5203
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005204/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
5205/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
5206/// given type to the candidate set.
5207static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
5208 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005209 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005210 unsigned NumArgs,
5211 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5212 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005213
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005214 // T& operator=(T&, T)
5215 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5216 ParamTypes[1] = T;
5217 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5218 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005219
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005220 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
5221 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005222 ParamTypes[0]
5223 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005224 ParamTypes[1] = T;
5225 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005226 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005227 }
5228}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005229
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00005230/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
5231/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005232static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
5233 Qualifiers VRQuals;
5234 const RecordType *TyRec;
5235 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
5236 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00005237 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005238 else
5239 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
5240 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005241 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005242 VRQuals.addVolatile();
5243 VRQuals.addRestrict();
5244 return VRQuals;
5245 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005246
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005247 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00005248 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
5249 return VRQuals;
5250
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00005251 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00005252 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005253
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00005254 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00005255 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00005256 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
5257 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5258 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5259 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005260 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
5261 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
5262 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
5263 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
5264 // as see them.
5265 bool done = false;
5266 while (!done) {
5267 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
5268 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005269 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005270 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
5271 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
5272 else
5273 done = true;
5274 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
5275 VRQuals.addVolatile();
5276 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
5277 VRQuals.addRestrict();
5278 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
5279 return VRQuals;
5280 }
5281 }
5282 }
5283 return VRQuals;
5284}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005285
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005286namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005287
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005288/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
5289/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
5290/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
5291/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
5292class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005293 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
5294 Sema &S;
5295 Expr **Args;
5296 unsigned NumArgs;
5297 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005298 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005299 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005300 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005301
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005302 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
5303 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005304 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
5305 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005306 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
5307 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
5308 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
5309 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
5310 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
5311 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
5312 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
5313
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005314 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
5315 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
5316 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
5317 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
5318 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
5319 // Start of promoted types.
5320 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
5321 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
5322 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005323
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005324 // Start of integral types.
5325 &ASTContext::IntTy,
5326 &ASTContext::LongTy,
5327 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
5328 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
5329 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
5330 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
5331 // End of promoted types.
5332
5333 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
5334 &ASTContext::CharTy,
5335 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
5336 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
5337 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
5338 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
5339 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
5340 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
5341 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
5342 // End of integral types.
5343 // FIXME: What about complex?
5344 };
5345 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
5346 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005347
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005348 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
5349 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
5350 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
5351 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
5352 // The rules are basically:
5353 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
5354 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
5355 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
5356 // - use the larger type
5357 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
5358 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
5359 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
5360 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
5361 // better not to make any assumptions).
5362 enum PromotedType {
5363 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
5364 };
5365 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
5366 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
5367 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
5368 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
5369 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
5370 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
5371 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
5372 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
5373 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
5374 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
5375 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
5376 };
5377
5378 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5379 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5380 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
5381
5382 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005383 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005384
5385 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
5386 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005387 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
5388 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005389 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
5390 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
5391
5392 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
5393 if (LW > RW) return LT;
5394 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
5395
5396 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
5397 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
5398 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
5399 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
5400 }
5401
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00005402 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
5403 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005404 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
5405 bool HasVolatile) {
5406 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5407 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
5408 S.Context.IntTy
5409 };
5410
5411 // Non-volatile version.
5412 if (NumArgs == 1)
5413 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5414 else
5415 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5416
5417 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
5418 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
5419 if (HasVolatile) {
5420 ParamTypes[0] =
5421 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
5422 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
5423 if (NumArgs == 1)
5424 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5425 else
5426 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5427 }
5428 }
5429
5430public:
5431 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
5432 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5433 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005434 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005435 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005436 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
5437 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
5438 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005439 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
5440 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005441 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
5442 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
5443 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005444 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005445 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005446 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
5447 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005448 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005449 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
5450 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005451 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005452 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
5453 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005454 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
5455 }
5456
5457 // C++ [over.built]p3:
5458 //
5459 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
5460 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
5461 // functions of the form
5462 //
5463 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
5464 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
5465 //
5466 // C++ [over.built]p4:
5467 //
5468 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
5469 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
5470 // candidate operator functions of the form
5471 //
5472 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
5473 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
5474 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005475 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5476 return;
5477
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005478 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
5479 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
5480 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005481 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005482 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
5483 }
5484 }
5485
5486 // C++ [over.built]p5:
5487 //
5488 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5489 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
5490 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5491 //
5492 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
5493 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
5494 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
5495 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
5496 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
5497 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5498 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5499 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5500 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5501 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005502 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005503 continue;
5504
5505 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
5506 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5507 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
5508 }
5509 }
5510
5511 // C++ [over.built]p6:
5512 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
5513 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5514 //
5515 // T& operator*(T*);
5516 //
5517 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005518 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005519 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005520 // T& operator*(T*);
5521 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
5522 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5523 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5524 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5525 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5526 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5527 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005528 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5529 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005530
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005531 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
5532 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
5533 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005534
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005535 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
5536 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5537 }
5538 }
5539
5540 // C++ [over.built]p9:
5541 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
5542 // operator functions of the form
5543 //
5544 // T operator+(T);
5545 // T operator-(T);
5546 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005547 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5548 return;
5549
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005550 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5551 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005552 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005553 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5554 }
5555
5556 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
5557 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5558 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5559 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5560 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5561 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5562 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5563 }
5564 }
5565
5566 // C++ [over.built]p8:
5567 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
5568 // the form
5569 //
5570 // T* operator+(T*);
5571 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
5572 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5573 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5574 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5575 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5576 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5577 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5578 }
5579 }
5580
5581 // C++ [over.built]p10:
5582 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
5583 // operator functions of the form
5584 //
5585 // T operator~(T);
5586 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005587 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5588 return;
5589
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005590 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5591 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005592 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005593 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5594 }
5595
5596 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
5597 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5598 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5599 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5600 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5601 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5602 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5603 }
5604 }
5605
5606 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
5607 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
5608 // functions of the form
5609 //
5610 // bool operator==(T,T);
5611 // bool operator!=(T,T);
5612 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
5613 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5614 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5615
5616 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5617 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5618 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5619 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5620 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
5621 ++MemPtr) {
5622 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5623 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5624 continue;
5625
5626 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5627 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5628 CandidateSet);
5629 }
5630 }
5631 }
5632
5633 // C++ [over.built]p15:
5634 //
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005635 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
5636 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005637 //
5638 // bool operator<(T, T);
5639 // bool operator>(T, T);
5640 // bool operator<=(T, T);
5641 // bool operator>=(T, T);
5642 // bool operator==(T, T);
5643 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005644 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5645 // C++ [over.built]p1:
5646 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
5647 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
5648 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
5649 // functions.
5650 //
5651 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
5652 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
5653 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
5654 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
5655 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
5656 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
5657 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
5658 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
5659 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
5660
5661 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5662 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
5663 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
5664 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
5665 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5666 C != CEnd; ++C) {
5667 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
5668 continue;
5669
5670 QualType FirstParamType =
5671 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5672 QualType SecondParamType =
5673 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5674
5675 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
5676 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
5677 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
5678 continue;
5679
5680 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
5681 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
5682 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
5683 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
5684 }
5685 }
5686 }
5687
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005688 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5689 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5690
5691 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5692 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5693 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5694 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5695 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5696 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5697 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5698 continue;
5699
5700 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5701 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5702 CandidateSet);
5703 }
5704 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5705 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5706 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5707 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5708 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
5709
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005710 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
5711 // candidate exists.
5712 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
5713 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
5714 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005715 continue;
5716
5717 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005718 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5719 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005720 }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005721
5722 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
5723 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
5724 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
5725 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
5726 NullPtrTy))) {
5727 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
5728 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5729 CandidateSet);
5730 }
5731 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005732 }
5733 }
5734
5735 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5736 //
5737 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
5738 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5739 //
5740 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5741 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
5742 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5743 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5744 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
5745 //
5746 // C++ [over.built]p14:
5747 //
5748 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
5749 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5750 //
5751 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5752 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5753 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5754 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5755
5756 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
5757 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
5758 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5759 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5760 };
5761 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5762 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
5763 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
5764 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005765 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5766 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
5767 continue;
5768
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005769 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
5770 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
5771 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
5772 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5773 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
5774 CandidateSet);
5775 }
5776 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
5777 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5778 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5779 continue;
5780
5781 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5782 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
5783 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5784 }
5785 }
5786 }
5787 }
5788
5789 // C++ [over.built]p12:
5790 //
5791 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
5792 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5793 //
5794 // LR operator*(L, R);
5795 // LR operator/(L, R);
5796 // LR operator+(L, R);
5797 // LR operator-(L, R);
5798 // bool operator<(L, R);
5799 // bool operator>(L, R);
5800 // bool operator<=(L, R);
5801 // bool operator>=(L, R);
5802 // bool operator==(L, R);
5803 // bool operator!=(L, R);
5804 //
5805 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5806 // between types L and R.
5807 //
5808 // C++ [over.built]p24:
5809 //
5810 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
5811 // candidate operator functions of the form
5812 //
5813 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
5814 //
5815 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5816 // between types L and R.
5817 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
5818 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005819 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5820 return;
5821
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005822 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5823 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
5824 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5825 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005826 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5827 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005828 QualType Result =
5829 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005830 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005831 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5832 }
5833 }
5834
5835 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
5836 // conditional operator for vector types.
5837 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5838 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5839 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5840 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5841 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5842 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5843 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5844 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5845 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
5846 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
5847 if (!isComparison) {
5848 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
5849 Result = *Vec1;
5850 else
5851 Result = *Vec2;
5852 }
5853
5854 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5855 }
5856 }
5857 }
5858
5859 // C++ [over.built]p17:
5860 //
5861 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
5862 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5863 //
5864 // LR operator%(L, R);
5865 // LR operator&(L, R);
5866 // LR operator^(L, R);
5867 // LR operator|(L, R);
5868 // L operator<<(L, R);
5869 // L operator>>(L, R);
5870 //
5871 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5872 // between types L and R.
5873 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005874 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5875 return;
5876
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005877 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5878 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
5879 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5880 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005881 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5882 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005883 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
5884 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005885 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005886 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5887 }
5888 }
5889 }
5890
5891 // C++ [over.built]p20:
5892 //
5893 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
5894 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
5895 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5896 //
5897 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
5898 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5899 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5900 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5901
5902 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5903 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5904 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5905 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5906 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5907 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5908 continue;
5909
5910 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
5911 CandidateSet);
5912 }
5913
5914 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5915 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5916 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5917 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5918 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5919 continue;
5920
5921 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
5922 CandidateSet);
5923 }
5924 }
5925 }
5926
5927 // C++ [over.built]p19:
5928 //
5929 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
5930 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
5931 // of the form
5932 //
5933 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
5934 //
5935 // C++ [over.built]p21:
5936 //
5937 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5938 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
5939 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5940 //
5941 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5942 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5943 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5944 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5945 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5946
5947 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5948 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5949 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5950 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5951 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
5952 if (isEqualOp)
5953 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005954 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
5955 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005956
5957 // non-volatile version
5958 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5959 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5960 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5961 };
5962 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5963 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
5964
5965 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5966 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5967 // volatile version
5968 ParamTypes[0] =
5969 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
5970 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5971 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5972 }
5973 }
5974
5975 if (isEqualOp) {
5976 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5977 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5978 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5979 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5980 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
5981 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5982 continue;
5983
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005984 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5985 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5986 *Ptr,
5987 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005988
5989 // non-volatile version
5990 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5991 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
5992
5993 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5994 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5995 // volatile version
5996 ParamTypes[0] =
5997 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005998 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5999 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006000 }
6001 }
6002 }
6003 }
6004
6005 // C++ [over.built]p18:
6006 //
6007 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
6008 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
6009 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
6010 // the form
6011 //
6012 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
6013 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
6014 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
6015 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
6016 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
6017 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006018 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6019 return;
6020
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006021 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
6022 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6023 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
6024 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006025 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006026
6027 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6028 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006029 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006030 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6031 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6032
6033 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
6034 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6035 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006036 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006037 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006038 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6039 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006040 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6041 }
6042 }
6043 }
6044
6045 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
6046 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6047 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6048 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6049 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
6050 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6051 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
6052 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
6053 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
6054 QualType ParamTypes[2];
6055 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
6056 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6057 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
6058 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6059 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6060
6061 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
6062 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6063 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
6064 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006065 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6066 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006067 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6068 }
6069 }
6070 }
6071 }
6072
6073 // C++ [over.built]p22:
6074 //
6075 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
6076 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
6077 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6078 //
6079 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
6080 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
6081 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
6082 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
6083 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
6084 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
6085 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006086 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6087 return;
6088
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006089 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
6090 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6091 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
6092 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006093 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006094
6095 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6096 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006097 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006098 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6099 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6100 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006101 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006102 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
6103 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
6104 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6105 CandidateSet);
6106 }
6107 }
6108 }
6109 }
6110
6111 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
6112 //
6113 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
6114 //
6115 // bool operator!(bool);
6116 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
6117 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
6118 void addExclaimOverload() {
6119 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
6120 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
6121 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
6122 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
6123 }
6124 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
6125 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
6126 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6127 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
6128 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
6129 }
6130
6131 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6132 //
6133 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
6134 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6135 //
6136 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
6137 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
6138 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
6139 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
6140 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
6141 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
6142 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6143 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6144 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6145 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6146 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
6147 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006148 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
6149 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006150
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006151 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
6152
6153 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
6154 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6155 }
6156
6157 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6158 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
6159 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
6160 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6161 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
6162 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006163 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
6164 continue;
6165
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006166 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
6167
6168 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
6169 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6170 }
6171 }
6172
6173 // C++ [over.built]p11:
6174 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
6175 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
6176 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
6177 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6178 //
6179 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
6180 //
6181 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
6182 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
6183 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6184 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6185 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6186 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6187 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
6188 QualType C1;
6189 QualifierCollector Q1;
6190 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
6191 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
6192 continue;
6193 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
6194 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
6195 // volatile/restrict type.
6196 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
6197 continue;
6198 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
6199 continue;
6200 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6201 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
6202 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
6203 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6204 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
6205 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
6206 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
6207 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
6208 break;
6209 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
6210 // build CV12 T&
6211 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
6212 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
6213 T.isVolatileQualified())
6214 continue;
6215 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
6216 T.isRestrictQualified())
6217 continue;
6218 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
6219 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6220 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6221 }
6222 }
6223 }
6224
6225 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
6226 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
6227 // therefore added as binary.
6228 //
6229 // C++ [over.built]p25:
6230 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
6231 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6232 //
6233 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
6234 //
6235 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
6236 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6237 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6238
6239 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
6240 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6241 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6242 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6243 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6244 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6245 continue;
6246
6247 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6248 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6249 }
6250
6251 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6252 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6253 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6254 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6255 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6256 continue;
6257
6258 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6259 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6260 }
6261
6262 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
6263 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6264 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6265 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6266 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6267 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
6268 continue;
6269
6270 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
6271 continue;
6272
6273 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
6274 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6275 }
6276 }
6277 }
6278 }
6279};
6280
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006281} // end anonymous namespace
6282
6283/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
6284/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
6285/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
6286/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
6287/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
6288void
6289Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6290 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6291 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6292 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006293 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
6294 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006295 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
6296 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006297 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
6298 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00006299 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6300 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006301
6302 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
6303 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006304 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00006305 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6306 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
6307 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
6308 OpLoc,
6309 true,
6310 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
6311 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
6312 Op == OO_PipePipe),
6313 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006314 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
6315 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
6316 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
6317 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
6318 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00006319 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006320
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006321 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
6322 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
6323 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType)
6324 return;
6325
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006326 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
6327 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
6328 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006329 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006330 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
6331
6332 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006333 switch (Op) {
6334 case OO_None:
6335 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006336 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006337 break;
6338
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006339 case OO_New:
6340 case OO_Delete:
6341 case OO_Array_New:
6342 case OO_Array_Delete:
6343 case OO_Call:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006344 llvm_unreachable(
6345 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006346 break;
6347
6348 case OO_Comma:
6349 case OO_Arrow:
6350 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6351 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6352 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006353 break;
6354
6355 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006356 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006357 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006358 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006359
6360 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006361 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006362 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006363 } else {
6364 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
6365 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6366 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006367 break;
6368
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006369 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006370 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006371 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
6372 else
6373 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6374 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006375
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006376 case OO_Slash:
6377 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006378 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006379
6380 case OO_PlusPlus:
6381 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006382 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6383 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006384 break;
6385
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006386 case OO_EqualEqual:
6387 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006388 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006389 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006390
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006391 case OO_Less:
6392 case OO_Greater:
6393 case OO_LessEqual:
6394 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006395 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006396 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
6397 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006398
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006399 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006400 case OO_Caret:
6401 case OO_Pipe:
6402 case OO_LessLess:
6403 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006404 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006405 break;
6406
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006407 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
6408 if (NumArgs == 1)
6409 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6410 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6411 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
6412 break;
6413
6414 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6415 break;
6416
6417 case OO_Tilde:
6418 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
6419 break;
6420
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006421 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006422 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006423 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006424
6425 case OO_PlusEqual:
6426 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006427 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006428 // Fall through.
6429
6430 case OO_StarEqual:
6431 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006432 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006433 break;
6434
6435 case OO_PercentEqual:
6436 case OO_LessLessEqual:
6437 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
6438 case OO_AmpEqual:
6439 case OO_CaretEqual:
6440 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006441 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006442 break;
6443
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006444 case OO_Exclaim:
6445 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006446 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006447
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006448 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006449 case OO_PipePipe:
6450 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006451 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006452
6453 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006454 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006455 break;
6456
6457 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006458 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006459 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00006460
6461 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006462 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006463 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6464 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006465 }
6466}
6467
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006468/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
6469/// to the set of overloading candidates.
6470///
6471/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
6472/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
6473/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
6474/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006475void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006476Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006477 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006478 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006479 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006480 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00006481 bool PartialOverloading,
6482 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006483 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006484
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00006485 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
6486 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
6487 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
6488 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
6489 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
6490 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
6491
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006492 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00006493 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns,
6494 StdNamespaceIsAssociated);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006495
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006496 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006497 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
6498 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6499 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006500 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006501 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006502 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006503 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006504 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006505
6506 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
6507 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006508 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006509 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006510 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006511 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006512 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006513
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006514 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00006515 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006516 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006517 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006518 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00006519 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006520 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006521}
6522
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006523/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
6524/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006525bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006526isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006527 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
6528 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006529 SourceLocation Loc,
6530 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006531 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
6532 // functions.
6533 if (!Cand2.Viable)
6534 return Cand1.Viable;
6535 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
6536 return false;
6537
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006538 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
6539 //
6540 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
6541 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
6542 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
6543 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
6544 unsigned StartArg = 0;
6545 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
6546 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006547
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006548 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006549 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
6550 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006551 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006552 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
6553 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
6554 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006555 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006556 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6557 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006558 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
6559 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6560 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6561 HasBetterConversion = true;
6562 break;
6563
6564 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6565 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6566 return false;
6567
6568 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6569 // Do nothing.
6570 break;
6571 }
6572 }
6573
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006574 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006575 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006576 if (HasBetterConversion)
6577 return true;
6578
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006579 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006580 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00006581 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006582 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
6583 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006584
6585 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
6586 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
6587 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006588 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00006589 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006590 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006591 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006592 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6593 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6594 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006595 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregorb837ea42011-01-11 17:34:58 +00006596 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006597 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006598 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006599 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006600
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006601 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
6602 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
6603 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
6604 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
6605 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
6606 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006607 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006608 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006609 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006610 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
6611 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006612 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
6613 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6614 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6615 return true;
6616
6617 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6618 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6619 return false;
6620
6621 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6622 // Do nothing
6623 break;
6624 }
6625 }
6626
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006627 return false;
6628}
6629
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006630/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006631/// within an overload candidate set.
6632///
6633/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
6634///
6635/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
6636/// which overload resolution occurs.
6637///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006638/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006639/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
6640///
6641/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006642OverloadingResult
6643OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006644 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00006645 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006646 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006647 Best = end();
6648 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
6649 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006650 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006651 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006652 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006653 }
6654
6655 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006656 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006657 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
6658
6659 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
6660 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006661 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006662 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006663 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006664 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006665 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006666 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006667 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006668 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006669 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006670
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006671 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006672 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00006673 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
6674 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006675 return OR_Deleted;
6676
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006677 return OR_Success;
6678}
6679
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006680namespace {
6681
6682enum OverloadCandidateKind {
6683 oc_function,
6684 oc_method,
6685 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006686 oc_function_template,
6687 oc_method_template,
6688 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006689 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
6690 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00006691 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006692 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00006693 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006694 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006695};
6696
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006697OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
6698 FunctionDecl *Fn,
6699 std::string &Description) {
6700 bool isTemplate = false;
6701
6702 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
6703 isTemplate = true;
6704 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6705 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
6706 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006707
6708 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006709 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006710 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006711
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006712 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
6713 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
6714
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00006715 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
6716 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
6717
6718 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
6719 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
6720
6721 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
6722 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
6723 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006724 }
6725
6726 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
6727 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
6728 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006729 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006730 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006731
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00006732 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6733 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
6734
Douglas Gregorec3bec02010-09-27 22:37:28 +00006735 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006736 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006737 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
6738 }
6739
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006740 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006741}
6742
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006743void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
6744 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
6745 if (!Ctor) return;
6746
6747 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
6748 if (!Ctor) return;
6749
6750 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
6751}
6752
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006753} // end anonymous namespace
6754
6755// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
6756void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006757 std::string FnDesc;
6758 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
6759 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6760 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006761 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006762}
6763
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00006764//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
6765// OverloadedExpr
6766void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr) {
6767 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
6768
6769 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
6770 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
6771
6772 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6773 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6774 I != IEnd; ++I) {
6775 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
6776 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6777 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
6778 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
6779 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6780 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun);
6781 }
6782 }
6783}
6784
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006785/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
6786/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
6787/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006788void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
6789 Sema &S,
6790 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
6791 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
6792 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
6793 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006794 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006795 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6796 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006797 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006798}
6799
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006800namespace {
6801
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006802void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
6803 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
6804 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006805 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
6806 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6807
6808 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
6809 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
6810 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006811 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006812 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006813 if (I == 0)
6814 isObjectArgument = true;
6815 else
6816 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006817 }
6818
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006819 std::string FnDesc;
6820 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
6821
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006822 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
6823 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
6824 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006825
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006826 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006827 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006828 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
6829 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
6830 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006831 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006832
6833 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
6834 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6835 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6836 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006837 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006838 return;
6839 }
6840
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006841 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
6842 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006843 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
6844 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
6845 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6846 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
6847 else {
6848 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
6849 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6850 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6851 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
6852 }
6853
6854 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
6855 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
6856 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
6857 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
6858 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6859 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
6860 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6861
6862 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6863 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6864
6865 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
6866 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
6867 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6868 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6869 << FromTy
6870 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
6871 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006872 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006873 return;
6874 }
6875
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006876 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscff00d92011-06-24 00:08:59 +00006877 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006878 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6879 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6880 << FromTy
6881 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
6882 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6883 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
6884 return;
6885 }
6886
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00006887 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
6888 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
6889 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6890 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6891 << FromTy
6892 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
6893 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6894 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
6895 return;
6896 }
6897
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006898 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
6899 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
6900
6901 if (isObjectArgument) {
6902 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
6903 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6904 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6905 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
6906 } else {
6907 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
6908 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6909 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6910 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
6911 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006912 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006913 return;
6914 }
6915
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006916 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
6917 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
6918 // the failure.
6919 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
6920 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6921 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6922 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
6923 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
6924 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6925 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6926 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006927 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006928 return;
6929 }
6930
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006931 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006932 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006933 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6934 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6935 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6936 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6937 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6938 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006939 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006940 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006941 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006942 }
6943 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
6944 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6945 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
6946 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6947 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6948 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6949 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6950 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6951 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006952 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
6953 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6954 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
6955 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
6956 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6957 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
6958 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
6959 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006960
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006961 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006962 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006963 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006964 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6965 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006966 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006967 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006968 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006969 return;
6970 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006971
Fariborz Jahaniana644f9c2011-07-20 17:14:09 +00006972 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
6973 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
6974 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6975 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6976 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
6977 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
6978 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6979 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6980 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6981 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
6982 return;
6983 }
6984 }
6985
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006986 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
6987 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
6988 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006989 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006990 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
6991 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
6992
6993 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006994 for (SmallVector<FixItHint, 1>::iterator
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006995 HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end();
6996 HI != HE; ++HI)
6997 FDiag << *HI;
6998 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
6999
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007000 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007001}
7002
7003void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7004 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
7005 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
7006
7007 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7008 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7009
7010 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007011
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00007012 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
7013 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
7014 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
7015 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
7016 // Just don't report anything.
7017 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
7018 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
7019 return;
7020
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007021 // at least / at most / exactly
7022 unsigned mode, modeCount;
7023 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007024 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
7025 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
7026 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007027 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregor7825bf32011-01-06 22:09:01 +00007028 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007029 mode = 0; // "at least"
7030 else
7031 mode = 2; // "exactly"
7032 modeCount = MinParams;
7033 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007034 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
7035 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
7036 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007037 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
7038 mode = 1; // "at most"
7039 else
7040 mode = 2; // "exactly"
7041 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
7042 }
7043
7044 std::string Description;
7045 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
7046
7047 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007048 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007049 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007050 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007051}
7052
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007053/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
7054void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7055 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7056 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
7057
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007058 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007059 NamedDecl *ParamD;
7060 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
7061 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
7062 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007063 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
7064 case Sema::TDK_Success:
7065 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
7066
7067 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007068 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
7069 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
7070 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007071 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007072 return;
7073 }
7074
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007075 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
7076 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
7077 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
7078
7079 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
7080
7081 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
7082 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00007083 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007084 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00007085 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007086 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
7087
7088 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
7089 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
7090 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
7091 // done on dependent types).
7092 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
7093
7094 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
7095 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007096 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007097 return;
7098 }
7099
7100 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007101 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007102 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007103 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007104 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007105 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007106 which = 1;
7107 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007108 which = 2;
7109 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007110
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007111 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007112 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007113 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
7114 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007115 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007116 return;
7117 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007118
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007119 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007120 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007121 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007122 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007123 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
7124 << ParamD->getDeclName();
7125 else {
7126 int index = 0;
7127 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
7128 index = TTP->getIndex();
7129 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
7130 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
7131 index = NTTP->getIndex();
7132 else
7133 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007134 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007135 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
7136 << (index + 1);
7137 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007138 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007139 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007140
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007141 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
7142 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
7143 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
7144 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007145
7146 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
7147 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007148 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007149 return;
7150
7151 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
7152 std::string ArgString;
7153 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
7154 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
7155 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7156 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
7157 *Args);
7158 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
7159 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007160 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007161 return;
7162 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007163
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007164 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
7165 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007166 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007167 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
7168 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007169 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007170 return;
7171 }
7172}
7173
7174/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
7175/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
7176///
7177/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
7178/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
7179/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
7180/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
7181/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
7182/// overload.
7183///
7184/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
7185/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
7186/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007187void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7188 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007189 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7190
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007191 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007192 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
7193 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007194 std::string FnDesc;
7195 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007196
7197 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007198 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007199 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007200 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007201 }
7202
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007203 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
7204 if (Cand->Viable) {
7205 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
7206 return;
7207 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007208
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007209 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
7210 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
7211 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
7212 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007213
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007214 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007215 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
7216
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007217 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
7218 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00007219 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007220 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007221
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007222 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
7223 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
7224 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007225 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
7226 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007227
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007228 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
7229 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
7230 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
7231 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007232 }
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007233 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007234}
7235
7236void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7237 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
7238 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
7239 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
7240 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
7241 bool isLValueReference = false;
7242 bool isRValueReference = false;
7243 bool isPointer = false;
7244 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
7245 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
7246 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7247 isLValueReference = true;
7248 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
7249 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
7250 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7251 isRValueReference = true;
7252 }
7253 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7254 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7255 isPointer = true;
7256 }
7257 // Desugar down to a function type.
7258 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
7259 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
7260 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
7261 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
7262 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
7263
7264 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
7265 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007266 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007267}
7268
7269void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
7270 const char *Opc,
7271 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7272 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7273 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
7274 std::string TypeStr("operator");
7275 TypeStr += Opc;
7276 TypeStr += "(";
7277 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
7278 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
7279 TypeStr += ")";
7280 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
7281 } else {
7282 TypeStr += ", ";
7283 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
7284 TypeStr += ")";
7285 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
7286 }
7287}
7288
7289void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7290 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7291 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
7292 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
7293 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007294 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
7295 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
7296
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007297 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007298 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007299 }
7300}
7301
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007302SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7303 if (Cand->Function)
7304 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00007305 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007306 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
7307 return SourceLocation();
7308}
7309
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00007310static unsigned
7311RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth73fddfe2011-09-10 00:51:24 +00007312 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00007313 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007314 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00007315
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00007316 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
7317 return 1;
7318
7319 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
7320 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
7321 return 2;
7322
7323 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
7324 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
7325 return 3;
7326
7327 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
7328 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
7329 return 4;
7330
7331 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
7332 return 5;
7333
7334 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
7335 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
7336 return 6;
7337 }
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00007338 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00007339}
7340
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007341struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
7342 Sema &S;
7343 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007344
7345 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
7346 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00007347 // Fast-path this check.
7348 if (L == R) return false;
7349
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007350 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007351 if (L->Viable) {
7352 if (!R->Viable) return true;
7353
7354 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
7355 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
7356 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007357 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
7358 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007359 } else if (R->Viable)
7360 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007361
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007362 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007363
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007364 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
7365 if (!L->Viable) {
7366 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
7367 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
7368 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
7369 return false;
7370 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
7371 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
7372 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007373
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007374 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
7375 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
7376 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
7377 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
7378 return true;
7379
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007380 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
7381 // comes first.
7382 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
7383 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
7384 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
7385 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00007386 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007387 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
7388 return true;
7389 else
7390 return false;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00007391 }
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007392
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007393 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
7394 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
7395 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
7396
7397 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00007398 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
7399 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007400 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7401 L->Conversions[I],
7402 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007403 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7404 leftBetter++;
7405 break;
7406
7407 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7408 leftBetter--;
7409 break;
7410
7411 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7412 break;
7413 }
7414 }
7415 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
7416 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
7417
7418 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
7419 return false;
7420
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00007421 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
7422 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
7423 return true;
7424
7425 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
7426 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
7427 <= RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
7428 }
7429
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007430 // TODO: others?
7431 }
7432
7433 // Sort everything else by location.
7434 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
7435 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
7436
7437 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
7438 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
7439 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
7440
7441 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007442 }
7443};
7444
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007445/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007446/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007447void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7448 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7449 assert(!Cand->Viable);
7450
7451 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
7452 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
7453
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007454 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
7455 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00007456 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
7457 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007458
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007459 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007460 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007461 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
7462 while (true) {
7463 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
7464 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007465 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00007466 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007467 break;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007468 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007469 }
7470
7471 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
7472 return;
7473
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007474 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
7475 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
7476
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00007477 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007478 // operation somehow.
7479 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007480
7481 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
7482 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
7483
7484 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
7485 QualType ConvType
7486 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7487 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7488 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
7489 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7490 ArgIdx--;
7491 } else if (Cand->Function) {
7492 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7493 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
7494 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
7495 ArgIdx--;
7496 } else {
7497 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
7498 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
7499 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
7500 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007501 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
7502 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007503 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007504 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
7505 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7506 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007507 return;
7508 }
7509
7510 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
7511 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
7512 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007513 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007514 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007515 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007516 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007517 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
7518 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7519 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007520 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
7521 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00007522 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007523 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007524 else
7525 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
7526 }
7527}
7528
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007529} // end anonymous namespace
7530
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007531/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
7532/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007533/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007534void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
7535 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
7536 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7537 const char *Opc,
7538 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007539 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
7540 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007541 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007542 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
7543 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007544 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007545 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007546 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007547 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007548 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
7549 Cands.push_back(Cand);
7550 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
7551 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007552 }
7553 }
7554
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007555 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007556 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007557
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007558 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007559
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007560 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007561 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007562 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007563 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7564 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00007565
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007566 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
7567 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
7568 // candidate list.
7569 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
7570 break;
7571 }
7572 ++CandsShown;
7573
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007574 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007575 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007576 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007577 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007578 else {
7579 assert(Cand->Viable &&
7580 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007581 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
7582 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
7583 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
7584 //
7585 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
7586 // different ambiguities, though.
7587 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007588 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007589 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
7590 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007591
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007592 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007593 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007594 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007595 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007596
7597 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007598 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007599}
7600
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007601// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
7602// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
7603// R (A) --> R(A)
7604// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
7605// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
7606// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
7607QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
7608 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
7609 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
7610 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
7611 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7612 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
7613 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7614 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007615 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007616 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7617 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7618 Ret =
7619 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
7620 return Ret;
7621}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007622
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007623// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
7624// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
7625class AddressOfFunctionResolver
7626{
7627 Sema& S;
7628 Expr* SourceExpr;
7629 const QualType& TargetType;
7630 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
7631
7632 bool Complain;
7633 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
7634 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007635
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007636 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
7637 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007638
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007639 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
7640 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
7641 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007642 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007643
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007644public:
7645 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
7646 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
7647 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
7648 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
7649 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
7650 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
7651 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
7652 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
7653 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
7654 {
7655 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
7656
7657 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
7658 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7659 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007660 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007661 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00007662
7663 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7664 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
7665 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
7666 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
7667 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
7668 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
7669
7670 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
7671 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
7672 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
7673 return;
7674 }
7675 }
7676
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007677 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
7678 }
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007679 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007680 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007681 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007682
7683 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
7684 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007685
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007686 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
7687 // C++ [over.over]p4:
7688 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
7689 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
7690 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
7691 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
7692 else
7693 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
7694 }
7695 }
7696 }
7697
7698private:
7699 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
7700 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
7701 }
7702
7703 // [ToType] [Return]
7704
7705 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7706 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7707 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
7708 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
7709 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
7710 }
7711
7712 // return true if any matching specializations were found
7713 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
7714 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
7715 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
7716 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
7717 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
7718 // static when converting to member pointer.
7719 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7720 return false;
7721 }
7722 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7723 return false;
7724
7725 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7726 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7727 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7728 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7729 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7730 // overloaded functions considered.
7731 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
7732 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
7733 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
7734 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
7735 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
7736 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
7737 Info)) {
7738 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7739 (void)Result;
7740 return false;
7741 }
7742
7743 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
7744 // This function template specicalization works.
7745 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
7746 assert(TargetFunctionType
7747 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
7748 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
7749 return true;
7750 }
7751
7752 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
7753 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007754 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007755 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
7756 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007757 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7758 return false;
7759 }
7760 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7761 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007762
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007763 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007764 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007765 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
7766 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00007767 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
7768 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007769 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
7770 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007771 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007772 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007773 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007774 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007775
7776 return false;
7777 }
7778
7779 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
7780 bool Ret = false;
7781
7782 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
7783 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
7784 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7785 return false;
7786
7787 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7788 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7789 I != E; ++I) {
7790 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
7791 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
7792
7793 // C++ [over.over]p3:
7794 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
7795 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
7796 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
7797 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
7798 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
7799 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7800 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
7801 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
7802 Ret = true;
7803 }
7804 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
7805 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
7806 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
7807 Ret = true;
7808 }
7809 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
7810 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007811 }
7812
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007813 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007814 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
7815 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
7816 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
7817 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
7818 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
7819
7820 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
7821 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
7822 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
7823 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007824
7825 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
7826 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
7827 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007828
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007829 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007830 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
7831 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
7832 S.PDiag(),
7833 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7834 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
7835 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7836 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
7837 Complain);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007838
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007839 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
7840 // Make it the first and only element
7841 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
7842 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
7843 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007844 }
7845 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007846
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007847 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
7848 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
7849 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
7850 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
7851 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
7852 ++I;
7853 else {
7854 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
7855 Matches.set_size(N);
7856 }
7857 }
7858 }
7859
7860public:
7861 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
7862 assert(Matches.empty());
7863 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
7864 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
7865 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7866 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7867 }
7868
7869 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7870 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
7871 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
7872 }
7873
7874 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7875 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
7876 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
7877 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
7878 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
7879 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7880 }
7881
7882 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
7883 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
7884 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
7885 }
7886
7887 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
7888 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
7889 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7890 << OvlExpr->getName()
7891 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7892 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7893 }
7894
7895 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
7896
7897 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
7898 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7899 return Matches[0].second;
7900 }
7901
7902 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
7903 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7904 return &Matches[0].first;
7905 }
7906};
7907
7908/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
7909/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
7910/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
7911/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
7912///
7913/// @code
7914/// int f(double);
7915/// int f(int);
7916///
7917/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
7918/// @endcode
7919///
7920/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
7921/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
7922/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
7923FunctionDecl *
7924Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
7925 bool Complain,
7926 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
7927
7928 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7929
7930 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, Complain);
7931 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
7932 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
7933 if ( NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
7934 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7935 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
7936 else
7937 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
7938 }
7939 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
7940 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
7941 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
7942 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
7943 assert(Fn);
7944 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
7945 MarkDeclarationReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00007946 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007947 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00007948 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007949
7950 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007951}
7952
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007953/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007954/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
7955///
7956/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
7957/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007958/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007959/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007960FunctionDecl *
7961Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
7962 bool Complain,
7963 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007964 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7965 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
7966 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007967 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7968 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
7969 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007970
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007971 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007972 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007973 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007974
7975 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007976 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007977
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007978 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
7979 // whose type matches exactly.
7980 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007981 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
7982 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007983 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
7984 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007985 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
7986 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
7987 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007988 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00007989 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7990 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007991
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007992 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7993 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7994 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7995 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7996 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7997 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007998 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007999 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008000 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
8001 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8002 Specialization, Info)) {
8003 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
8004 (void)Result;
8005 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008006 }
8007
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008008 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
8009
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008010 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008011 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008012 if (Complain) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008013 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8014 << ovl->getName();
8015 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008016 }
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008017 return 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008018 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008019
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008020 Matched = Specialization;
8021 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008022 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008023
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008024 return Matched;
8025}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008026
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008027
8028
8029
8030// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that
8031// can be resolved because it identifies a single function
8032// template specialization
8033// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
8034ExprResult Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008035 Expr *SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, bool complain,
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008036 const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
8037 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008038 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
8039 assert(SrcExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008040
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008041 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008042
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008043 DeclAccessPair found;
8044 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
8045 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
8046 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
8047 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin()))
8048 return ExprError();
8049
8050 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
8051 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
8052 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
8053 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
8054 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
8055 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
8056 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
8057 if (complain) {
8058 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
8059 diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8060 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
8061 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
8062 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
8063 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
8064 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
8065 // the static candidates were rejected.
8066 }
8067
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00008068 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008069 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00008070
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008071 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'.
8072 SingleFunctionExpression =
8073 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr, found, fn));
8074
8075 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
8076 if (doFunctionPointerConverion)
8077 SingleFunctionExpression =
8078 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
8079 }
8080
8081 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
8082 if (complain) {
8083 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
8084 << ovl.Expression->getName()
8085 << DestTypeForComplaining
8086 << OpRangeForComplaining
8087 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
8088 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr);
8089 }
8090 return ExprError();
8091 }
8092
8093 return SingleFunctionExpression;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008094}
8095
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008096/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
8097static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008098 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00008099 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008100 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8101 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008102 bool PartialOverloading,
8103 bool KnownValid) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008104 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008105 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
8106 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
8107
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008108 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008109 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
8110 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
8111 return;
8112 }
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008113 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00008114 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008115 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008116 }
8117
8118 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
8119 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008120 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
8121 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008122 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008123 return;
8124 }
8125
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008126 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008127}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008128
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008129/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
8130/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008131void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008132 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8133 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
8134 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008135
8136#ifndef NDEBUG
8137 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
8138 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008139 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008140 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
8141 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
8142 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
8143 //
8144 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
8145 //
8146 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008147 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008148 //
8149 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
8150 // template
8151 //
8152 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008153
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008154 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
8155 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
8156 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8157 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
8158 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
8159 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
8160 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008161 }
8162 }
8163#endif
8164
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008165 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
8166 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00008167 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008168 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8169 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
8170 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
8171 }
8172
8173 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
8174 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008175 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008176 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008177 PartialOverloading, /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008178
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008179 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008180 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
8181 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008182 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008183 CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00008184 PartialOverloading,
8185 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace());
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008186}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008187
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008188/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
8189/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
8190/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
8191/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
8192///
8193/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
8194static bool
8195DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
8196 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
8197 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8198 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8199 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
8200 return false;
8201
8202 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
8203 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
8204
8205 if (!R.empty()) {
8206 R.suppressDiagnostics();
8207
8208 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
8209 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
8210 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
8211 R.clear();
8212 return false;
8213 }
8214
8215 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
8216 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
8217 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
8218 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008219 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008220
8221 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008222 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008223 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
8224 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008225 R.clear();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008226 return false;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008227 }
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008228
8229 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
8230 // declaring the function there instead.
8231 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
8232 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
8233 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(Args, NumArgs,
8234 AssociatedNamespaces,
8235 AssociatedClasses);
8236 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008237 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008238 if (DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008239 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
8240 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008241 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
8242 if (!Std->Encloses(*it))
8243 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
8244 }
Chandler Carruthd54186a2011-06-08 10:13:17 +00008245 } else {
8246 // Lacking the 'std::' namespace, use all of the associated namespaces.
8247 SuggestedNamespaces = AssociatedNamespaces;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008248 }
8249
8250 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8251 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008252 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008253 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8254 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8255 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008256 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008257 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8258 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008259 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008260 } else {
8261 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
8262 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
8263 // a localized representation of a list of items.
8264 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8265 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8266 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
8267 }
8268
8269 // Try to recover by calling this function.
8270 return true;
8271 }
8272
8273 R.clear();
8274 }
8275
8276 return false;
8277}
8278
8279/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
8280/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
8281/// was defined.
8282///
8283/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
8284static bool
8285DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
8286 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8287 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8288 DeclarationName OpName =
8289 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8290 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
8291 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
8292 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args, NumArgs);
8293}
8294
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008295/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
8296///
8297/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008298static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00008299BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008300 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
8301 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
8302 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008303 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
8304 bool EmptyLookup) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008305
8306 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008307 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008308
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008309 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008310 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008311 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8312 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
8313 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
8314 }
8315
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008316 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
8317 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008318 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
8319 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs) &&
8320 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrainacbdc572011-08-03 20:36:05 +00008321 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression,
Kaelyn Uhrain42830922011-08-05 00:09:52 +00008322 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs)))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008323 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008324
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008325 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
8326
8327 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
8328 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008329 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008330 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008331 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
8332 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008333 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
8334 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
8335 else
8336 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
8337
8338 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008339 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008340
8341 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008342 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008343 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008344 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008345 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008346}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00008347
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008348/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008349/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
8350/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
8351/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
8352/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00008353/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008354/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008355ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00008356Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008357 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
8358 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00008359 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
8360 Expr *ExecConfig) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008361#ifndef NDEBUG
8362 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
8363 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
8364 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
8365
8366 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
8367 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
8368 FunctionDecl *F;
8369 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
8370 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
8371 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008372 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008373
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008374 // We don't perform ADL in C.
8375 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00008376 } else
8377 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() &&
8378 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL");
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008379#endif
8380
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008381 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00008382
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008383 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
8384 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
8385 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008386
8387 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008388 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
8389 // out if it fails.
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00008390 if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
8391 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
8392 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
8393 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
8394 // classes.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +00008395 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00008396 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
8397 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
8398 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
8399 RParenLoc);
8400 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
8401 return Owned(CE);
8402 }
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00008403 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008404 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true);
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00008405 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008406
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008407 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008408 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008409 case OR_Success: {
8410 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008411 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008412 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008413 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(),
8414 ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008415 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00008416 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
8417 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008418 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008419
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008420 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8421 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
8422 // have meant to call.
8423 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
8424 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
8425 /*EmptyLookup=*/false);
8426 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
8427 return Recovery;
8428
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00008429 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008430 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008431 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008432 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008433 break;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008434 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008435
8436 case OR_Ambiguous:
8437 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008438 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008439 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008440 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008441
8442 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00008443 {
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008444 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
8445 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8446 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008447 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008448 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00008449 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8450 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008451 break;
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008452 }
8453
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008454 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008455 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008456}
8457
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008458static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00008459 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
8460 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
8461}
8462
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008463/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8464/// operator.
8465///
8466/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
8467///
8468/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8469/// operator.
8470///
8471/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8472/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8473/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8474/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8475/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8476/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
8477///
8478/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008479ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008480Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
8481 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008482 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008483 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008484
8485 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8486 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
8487 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008488 // TODO: provide better source location info.
8489 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008490
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008491 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8492 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input);
8493 if (Result.isInvalid())
8494 return ExprError();
8495 Input = Result.take();
8496 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008497
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008498 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
8499 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008500
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008501 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
8502 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
8503 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008504 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008505 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00008506 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
8507 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008508 NumArgs = 2;
8509 }
8510
8511 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00008512 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008513 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008514 Opc,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00008515 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008516 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00008517 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008518
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008519 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008520 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00008521 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008522 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008523 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
8524 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008525 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008526 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008527 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008528 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008529 OpLoc));
8530 }
8531
8532 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008533 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008534
8535 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008536 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008537
8538 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8539 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
8540
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008541 // Add candidates from ADL.
8542 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00008543 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008544 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8545 CandidateSet);
8546
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008547 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00008548 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008549
8550 // Perform overload resolution.
8551 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008552 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008553 case OR_Success: {
8554 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8555 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008556
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008557 if (FnDecl) {
8558 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8559 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008560
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008561 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8562
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008563 // Convert the arguments.
8564 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008565 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008566
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008567 ExprResult InputRes =
8568 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
8569 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8570 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008571 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008572 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008573 } else {
8574 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008575 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00008576 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008577 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00008578 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008579 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008580 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00008581 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008582 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008583 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008584 }
8585
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008586 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8587
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008588 // Determine the result type.
8589 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8590 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8591 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008592
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008593 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008594 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl);
8595 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8596 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008597
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00008598 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008599 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008600 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008601 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008602
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008603 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00008604 FnDecl))
8605 return ExprError();
8606
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008607 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008608 } else {
8609 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8610 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8611 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008612 ExprResult InputRes =
8613 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8614 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8615 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
8616 return ExprError();
8617 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008618 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008619 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008620 }
8621
8622 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008623 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
8624 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
8625 // defined too late to be candidates.
8626 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, NumArgs))
8627 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
8628 return ExprError();
8629
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008630 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
8631 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
8632 break;
8633
8634 case OR_Ambiguous:
8635 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8636 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8637 << Input->getType()
8638 << Input->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00008639 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008640 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
8641 return ExprError();
8642
8643 case OR_Deleted:
8644 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8645 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8646 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8647 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
8648 << Input->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00008649 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
8650 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008651 return ExprError();
8652 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008653
8654 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
8655 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
8656 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008657 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008658}
8659
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008660/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8661/// operator.
8662///
8663/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
8664///
8665/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8666/// operator.
8667///
8668/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8669/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8670/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8671/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8672/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8673/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
8674///
8675/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
8676/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008677ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008678Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008679 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008680 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008681 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008682 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008683 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008684
8685 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
8686 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8687 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8688
8689 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8690 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008691 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008692 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008693 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008694 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008695 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008696 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008697 Context.DependentTy,
8698 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8699 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008700
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008701 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
8702 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008703 VK_LValue,
8704 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008705 Context.DependentTy,
8706 Context.DependentTy,
8707 OpLoc));
8708 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008709
8710 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008711 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008712 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
8713 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008714 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008715 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
8716 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
8717 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008718 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008719 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008720 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008721 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008722 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008723 OpLoc));
8724 }
8725
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008726 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008727 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8728 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8729 if (Result.isInvalid())
8730 return ExprError();
8731 Args[1] = Result.take();
8732 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008733
8734 // The LHS is more complicated.
8735 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8736
8737 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
8738 // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
8739 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
8740 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
8741
8742 // Is the property "logically" settable?
8743 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
8744 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
8745
8746 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
8747 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care:
8748 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
8749 // load and hope.
8750 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
8751 // we really should use the primitive.
8752 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
8753 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works
8754 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
8755 // on the property, and otherwise just error.
8756 if (Settable)
8757 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8758 }
8759
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008760 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8761 if (Result.isInvalid())
8762 return ExprError();
8763 Args[0] = Result.take();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008764 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008765
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00008766 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
8767 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
8768 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
8769 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
8770 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
8771 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008772 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008773 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008774
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008775 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
8776 // create a built-in binary operator.
8777 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
8778 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8779
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008780 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008781 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008782
8783 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008784 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008785
8786 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8787 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8788
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008789 // Add candidates from ADL.
8790 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
8791 Args, 2,
8792 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8793 CandidateSet);
8794
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008795 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00008796 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008797
8798 // Perform overload resolution.
8799 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008800 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00008801 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008802 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8803 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8804
8805 if (FnDecl) {
8806 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8807 // operator.
8808
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008809 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8810
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008811 // Convert the arguments.
8812 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008813 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008814 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008815
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008816 ExprResult Arg1 =
8817 PerformCopyInitialization(
8818 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8819 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8820 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008821 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008822 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008823
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008824 ExprResult Arg0 =
8825 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8826 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8827 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008828 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008829 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008830 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008831 } else {
8832 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008833 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
8834 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8835 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8836 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008837 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008838 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008839
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008840 ExprResult Arg1 =
8841 PerformCopyInitialization(
8842 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8843 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
8844 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008845 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
8846 return ExprError();
8847 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
8848 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008849 }
8850
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008851 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8852
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008853 // Determine the result type.
8854 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8855 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8856 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008857
8858 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008859 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc);
8860 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8861 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008862
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008863 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008864 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008865 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008866
8867 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008868 FnDecl))
8869 return ExprError();
8870
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008871 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008872 } else {
8873 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8874 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8875 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008876 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8877 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8878 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8879 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008880 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008881 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008882
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008883 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8884 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8885 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8886 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8887 return ExprError();
8888 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008889 break;
8890 }
8891 }
8892
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008893 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8894 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
8895 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
8896 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
8897 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008898 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008899 break;
8900
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008901 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
8902 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
8903 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008904 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008905 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008906 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008907 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
8908 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008909 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008910 } else {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008911 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
8912 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
8913 // defined too late to be candidates.
8914 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, 2))
8915 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
8916 return ExprError();
8917
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008918 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
8919 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
8920 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008921 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008922 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008923 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
8924 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008925 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8926 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008927 return move(Result);
8928 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008929
8930 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008931 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008932 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008933 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008934 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008935 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8936 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008937 return ExprError();
8938
8939 case OR_Deleted:
8940 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8941 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8942 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008943 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008944 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00008945 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8946 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008947 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008948 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008949
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008950 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008951 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008952}
8953
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008954ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008955Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
8956 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008957 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
8958 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008959 DeclarationName OpName =
8960 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
8961
8962 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8963 // expression.
8964 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
8965
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008966 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008967 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
8968 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
8969 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008970 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00008971 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008972 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008973 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
8974 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
8975 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008976 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008977
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008978 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
8979 Args, 2,
8980 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008981 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008982 RLoc));
8983 }
8984
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008985 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8986 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8987 if (Result.isInvalid())
8988 return ExprError();
8989 Args[0] = Result.take();
8990 }
8991 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8992 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8993 if (Result.isInvalid())
8994 return ExprError();
8995 Args[1] = Result.take();
8996 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008997
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008998 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008999 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009000
9001 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
9002
9003 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9004 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9005
9006 // Add builtin operator candidates.
9007 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9008
9009 // Perform overload resolution.
9010 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009011 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009012 case OR_Success: {
9013 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9014 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
9015
9016 if (FnDecl) {
9017 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9018 // operator.
9019
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009020 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
9021
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009022 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009023 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009024
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009025 // Convert the arguments.
9026 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009027 ExprResult Arg0 =
9028 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
9029 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9030 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009031 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009032 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009033
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009034 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009035 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009036 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009037 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009038 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009039 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009040 Owned(Args[1]));
9041 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
9042 return ExprError();
9043
9044 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
9045
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009046 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009047 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9048 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9049 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009050
9051 // Build the actual expression node.
Douglas Gregore9d62932011-07-15 16:25:15 +00009052 DeclarationNameLoc LocInfo;
9053 LocInfo.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = LLoc.getRawEncoding();
9054 LocInfo.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = RLoc.getRawEncoding();
9055 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc, LocInfo);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009056 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9057 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009058
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009059 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
9060 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009061 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009062 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009063
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009064 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009065 FnDecl))
9066 return ExprError();
9067
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009068 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009069 } else {
9070 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9071 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9072 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009073 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
9074 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9075 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9076 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009077 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009078 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
9079
9080 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
9081 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
9082 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
9083 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
9084 return ExprError();
9085 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009086
9087 break;
9088 }
9089 }
9090
9091 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009092 if (CandidateSet.empty())
9093 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
9094 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
9095 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9096 else
9097 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
9098 << Args[0]->getType()
9099 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009100 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9101 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009102 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009103 }
9104
9105 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009106 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009107 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009108 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
9109 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009110 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
9111 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009112 return ExprError();
9113
9114 case OR_Deleted:
9115 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9116 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009117 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009118 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009119 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9120 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009121 return ExprError();
9122 }
9123
9124 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009125 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009126}
9127
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009128/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
9129/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
9130/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
9131/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
9132/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009133/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
9134/// member function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009135ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009136Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
9137 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00009138 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009139 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
9140 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
9141
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009142 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
9143 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009144 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009145
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009146 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
9147 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
9148 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
9149 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
9150
9151 QualType fnType =
9152 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9153
9154 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9155 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
9156 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
9157
9158 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
9159 // member function we're calling.
9160 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
9161
9162 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
9163 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
9164 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9165 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
9166
9167 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
9168 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
9169 difference.removeAddressSpace();
9170 if (difference) {
9171 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
9172 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
9173 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
9174 << qualsString
9175 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
9176 }
9177
9178 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
9179 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
9180 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
9181
9182 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
9183 op->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
9184 call, 0))
9185 return ExprError();
9186
9187 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
9188 return ExprError();
9189
9190 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
9191 }
9192
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009193 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009194 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +00009195 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00009196 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009197 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
9198 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009199 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009200 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00009201 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009202 } else {
9203 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00009204 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009205
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009206 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009207 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
9208 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
9209 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009210
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009211 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009212 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009213
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009214 // FIXME: avoid copy.
9215 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9216 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9217 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9218 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9219 }
9220
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009221 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
9222 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9223
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009224 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
9225 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
9226 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
9227 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
9228
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009229
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +00009230 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +00009231 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +00009232 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
9233 CandidateSet);
9234 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00009235 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
9236 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009237 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00009238 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009239
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009240 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009241 ObjectClassification,
9242 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009243 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009244 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009245 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009246 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009247 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009248 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00009249 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009250 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00009251 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009252
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009253 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
9254
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009255 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009256 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00009257 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009258 case OR_Success:
9259 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009260 MarkDeclarationReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009261 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009262 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009263 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009264 break;
9265
9266 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009267 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009268 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00009269 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009270 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009271 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009272 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009273
9274 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009275 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00009276 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009277 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009278 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009279 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009280
9281 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009282 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009283 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009284 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009285 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009286 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009287 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009288 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009289 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009290 }
9291
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009292 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009293
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009294 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
9295 // non-member call based on that function.
9296 if (Method->isStatic()) {
9297 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
9298 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
9299 }
9300
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009301 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009302 }
9303
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009304 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
9305 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
9306 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9307
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009308 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009309 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009310 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009311 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009312
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00009313 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009314 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009315 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009316 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009317
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009318 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009319 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
9320 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009321 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9322 ExprResult ObjectArg =
9323 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
9324 FoundDecl, Method);
9325 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
9326 return ExprError();
9327 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
9328 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009329
9330 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009331 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
9332 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009333 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009334 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009335 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009336
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009337 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009338 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +00009339
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +00009340 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
9341 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
9342 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
9343 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
9344
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +00009345 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +00009346 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
9347 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
9348 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
9349 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
9350
9351 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +00009352 }
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +00009353 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009354 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009355}
9356
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009357/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
9358/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
9359/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
9360/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009361ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009362Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +00009363 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009364 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009365 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009366 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
9367 if (Object.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
9368 Object = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object.take());
9369 if (Object.isInvalid())
9370 return ExprError();
9371 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009372
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009373 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
9374 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009375
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009376 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
9377 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +00009378 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009379 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
9380 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
9381 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
9382 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009383 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00009384 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00009385
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009386 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00009387 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009388 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00009389 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009390
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00009391 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
9392 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
9393 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9394
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00009395 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00009396 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009397 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
9398 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00009399 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00009400 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009401
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009402 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +00009403 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
9404 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009405 //
9406 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
9407 //
9408 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
9409 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +00009410 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
9411 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
9412 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
9413 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009414 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
9415 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
9416 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
9417 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
9418 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00009419 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +00009420 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00009421 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009422 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009423 NamedDecl *D = *I;
9424 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
9425 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
9426 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009427
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00009428 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
9429 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009430 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00009431 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009432
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009433 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +00009434 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
9435 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
9436 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
9437 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9438 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9439 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009440
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +00009441 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9442 {
9443 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
9444 Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
9445 }
9446 }
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009447 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009448
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009449 // Perform overload resolution.
9450 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009451 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009452 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009453 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009454 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
9455 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009456 break;
9457
9458 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009459 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009460 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
9461 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
9462 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009463 else
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009464 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009465 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009466 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009467 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009468 break;
9469
9470 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009471 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009472 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009473 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009474 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009475 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009476
9477 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009478 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009479 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
9480 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009481 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009482 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009483 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009484 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009485 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009486 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009487
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009488 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009489 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009490
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009491 if (Best->Function == 0) {
9492 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
9493 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009494 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009495 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
9496 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
9497
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009498 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009499 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00009500
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009501 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
9502 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
9503 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009504
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00009505 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00009506 // and then call it.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009507 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, Conv);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00009508 if (Call.isInvalid())
9509 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009510
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00009511 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00009512 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009513 }
9514
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009515 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009516 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009517 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00009518
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009519 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
9520 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
9521 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
9522 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009523 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
9524 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009525
9526 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
9527 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
9528
9529 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
9530 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
9531 // list).
9532 Expr **MethodArgs;
9533 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
9534 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
9535 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
9536 } else {
9537 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
9538 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009539 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009540 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
9541 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009542
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009543 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
9544 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
9545 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009546
9547 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
9548 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009549 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9550 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9551 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9552
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009553 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009554 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009555 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009556 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009557 delete [] MethodArgs;
9558
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009559 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +00009560 Method))
9561 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009562
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009563 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
9564 // slots in the call for them.
9565 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00009566 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009567 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
9568 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
9569
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00009570 bool IsError = false;
9571
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009572 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009573 ExprResult ObjRes =
9574 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
9575 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9576 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
9577 IsError = true;
9578 else
9579 Object = move(ObjRes);
9580 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00009581
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009582 // Check the argument types.
9583 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009584 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009585 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009586 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009587
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009588 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009589
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009590 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009591 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009592 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009593 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009594 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009595
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009596 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
9597 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009598 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009599 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00009600 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
9601 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
9602 IsError = true;
9603 break;
9604 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009605
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00009606 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009607 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009608
9609 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
9610 }
9611
9612 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
9613 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
9614 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
9615 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009616 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
9617 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
9618 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009619 }
9620 }
9621
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00009622 if (IsError) return true;
9623
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009624 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00009625 return true;
9626
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +00009627 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009628}
9629
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009630/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009631/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009632/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009633ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009634Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009635 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
9636 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009637
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009638 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
9639 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base);
9640 if (Result.isInvalid())
9641 return ExprError();
9642 Base = Result.take();
9643 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009644
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009645 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
9646
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009647 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
9648 //
9649 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
9650 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
9651 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
9652 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009653 DeclarationName OpName =
9654 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009655 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00009656 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009657
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009658 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +00009659 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
9660 << Base->getSourceRange()))
9661 return ExprError();
9662
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00009663 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
9664 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
9665 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00009666
9667 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009668 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009669 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
9670 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009671 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009672
9673 // Perform overload resolution.
9674 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009675 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009676 case OR_Success:
9677 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
9678 break;
9679
9680 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
9681 if (CandidateSet.empty())
9682 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009683 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009684 else
9685 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009686 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009687 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009688 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009689
9690 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009691 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
9692 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009693 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009694 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009695
9696 case OR_Deleted:
9697 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9698 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009699 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009700 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009701 << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009702 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009703 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009704 }
9705
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009706 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009707 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009708 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009709
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009710 // Convert the object parameter.
9711 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009712 ExprResult BaseResult =
9713 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
9714 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9715 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009716 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009717 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +00009718
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009719 // Build the operator call.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009720 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
9721 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9722 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009723
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009724 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9725 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9726 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009727 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009728 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009729 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009730
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009731 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009732 Method))
9733 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +00009734
9735 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009736}
9737
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009738/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
9739/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
9740/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
9741/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00009742/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00009743Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009744 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009745 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009746 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
9747 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009748 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009749 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009750
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009751 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009752 }
9753
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009754 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009755 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
9756 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009757 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009758 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00009759 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009760 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009761 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009762 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009763
9764 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009765 ICE->getCastKind(),
9766 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00009767 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009768 }
9769
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009770 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009771 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009772 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009773 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9774 if (Method->isStatic()) {
9775 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
9776 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009777 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009778 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
9779 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
9780 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009781 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9782 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009783 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009784 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009785
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009786 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
9787 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
9788 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
9789 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
9790
9791 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
9792 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
9793 // appropriate pointer to member type.
9794 QualType ClassType
9795 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
9796 QualType MemPtrType
9797 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
9798
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009799 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
9800 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9801 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009802 }
9803 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009804 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9805 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009806 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009807 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009808
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009809 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009810 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009811 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009812 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009813 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009814
9815 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009816 // FIXME: avoid copy.
9817 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009818 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009819 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9820 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009821 }
9822
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009823 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009824 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009825 Fn,
9826 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009827 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009828 VK_LValue,
Chandler Carruth8d26bb02011-05-01 23:48:14 +00009829 Found.getDecl(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009830 TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009831 }
9832
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009833 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009834 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009835 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9836 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9837 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9838 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9839 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009840
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009841 Expr *Base;
9842
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009843 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
9844 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009845 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
9846 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9847 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009848 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009849 Fn,
9850 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
9851 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009852 VK_LValue,
Chandler Carruth8d26bb02011-05-01 23:48:14 +00009853 Found.getDecl(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009854 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009855 } else {
9856 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
9857 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009858 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009859 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
9860 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
9861 /*isImplicit=*/true);
9862 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009863 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009864 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009865
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009866 ExprValueKind valueKind;
9867 QualType type;
9868 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9869 valueKind = VK_LValue;
9870 type = Fn->getType();
9871 } else {
9872 valueKind = VK_RValue;
9873 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
9874 }
9875
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009876 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009877 MemExpr->isArrow(),
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009878 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009879 Fn,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009880 Found,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009881 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009882 TemplateArgs,
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009883 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009884 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009885
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009886 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
9887 return E;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009888}
9889
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009890ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009891 DeclAccessPair Found,
9892 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009893 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00009894}
9895
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009896} // end namespace clang